blob: 4d575856e035eb53a8b0dd6174381df815509b60 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3ecbd92012-12-28 15:04:05 +01007 2012/12/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100482 - tune.ssl.lifetime
483 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100484 - tune.zlib.memlevel
485 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487 * Debugging
488 - debug
489 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490
491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004923.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493------------------------------------
494
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200495ca-base <dir>
496 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200497 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
498 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500chroot <jail dir>
501 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
502 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
503 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
504 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
505 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
506 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100507
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100508cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
509 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
510 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
511 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
512 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
513 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
514 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
515 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
516 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
517 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
518 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
519 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
520 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
521 they overlap.
522
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523crt-base <dir>
524 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
525 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
526 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
527
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528daemon
529 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
530 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
531 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
532
533gid <number>
534 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
535 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
536 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100537 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
538 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541group <group name>
542 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
543 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100544
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200545log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
547 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100548 configured with "log global".
549
550 <address> can be one of:
551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100552 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100553 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
554 port).
555
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100556 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
557 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
558 port).
559
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100560 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
561 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
562 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
563 writeable).
564
565 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566
567 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
568 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
569 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
570
571 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200572 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
573 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
574 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
575 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
576 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
577 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200579 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100581log-send-hostname [<string>]
582 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
583 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
584 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
585 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
586 the logs.
587
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000588log-tag <string>
589 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
590 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
591 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
592 running on the same host.
593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594nbproc <number>
595 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
596 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
597 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
598 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
599 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
600
601pidfile <pidfile>
602 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
603 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
604 starting the process. See also "daemon".
605
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100606stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200607 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
608 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
609 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
610 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
611 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
612 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
613 the number of processes used.
614
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200615stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
616 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
617 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
618 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
619 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200620
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200621 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
622 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
623 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200624
625stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
626 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
627 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100628 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200629
630stats maxconn <connections>
631 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
632 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634uid <number>
635 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
636 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
637 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
638 one. See also "gid" and "user".
639
640ulimit-n <number>
641 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
642 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
643 option.
644
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100645unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
646 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
647
648 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
649 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
650 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
651 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
652 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
653 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
654 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
655 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
656 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
657 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659user <user name>
660 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
661 See also "uid" and "group".
662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200663node <name>
664 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
665
666 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
667 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
668 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
669 traffic.
670
671description <text>
672 Add a text that describes the instance.
673
674 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
675 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
676 "<" and ">" characters.
677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680-----------------------
681
682maxconn <number>
683 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
684 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
685 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
686 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
687
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200688maxconnrate <number>
689 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
690 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
691 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
692 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
693 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
694 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
695 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
696 fairness.
697
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100698maxcomprate <number>
699 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
700 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
701 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
702 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
703 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
704 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
705 default value.
706
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100707maxcompcpuusage <number>
708 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
709 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
710 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
711 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
712 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
713 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
714 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
715 process down and from introducing high latencies.
716
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100717maxpipes <number>
718 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
719 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
720 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
721 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
722 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
723 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
724
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200725maxsslconn <number>
726 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
727 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
728 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
729 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
730 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
731 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
732 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
733
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100734maxzlibmem <number>
735 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
736 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
737 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100738 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
739 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
740 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742noepoll
743 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
744 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100745 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747nokqueue
748 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
749 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
750 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
751
752nopoll
753 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
754 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100755 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100758nosplice
759 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
760 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
761 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100762 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100763 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
764 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
765 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
766 "option splice-response".
767
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200768spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
769 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
770 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
771 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
772 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
773 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
774
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200775tune.bufsize <number>
776 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
777 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
778 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
779 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
780 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
781 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
782 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
783 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400784 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
785 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
786 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200788tune.chksize <number>
789 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
790 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
791 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
792 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
793 checks whenever possible.
794
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100795tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
796 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
797 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
798 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
799 this value. The default value is 1.
800
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100801tune.http.cookielen <number>
802 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
803 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
804 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
805 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
806 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
807 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
808 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
809 to change this value.
810
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200811tune.http.maxhdr <number>
812 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
813 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
814 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
815 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
816 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
817 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
818 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
819 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
820 limit too high.
821
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100822tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100823 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
824 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
825 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
826 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
827 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
828 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
829 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
830 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
831 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
832 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833
834tune.maxpollevents <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
836 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
837 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
838 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
839 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
840
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200841tune.maxrewrite <number>
842 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
843 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
844 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
845 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
846 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
847 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
848 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
849 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
850 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
851 bufsize.
852
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200853tune.pipesize <number>
854 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
855 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
856 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
857 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
858 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
859 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
860
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100861tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
862tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
863 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
864 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
865 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
866 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
867 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
868 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
869 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
870
871tune.sndbuf.client <number>
872tune.sndbuf.server <number>
873 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
874 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
876 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
880 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
881 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
882 notifying haproxy again.
883
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100884tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100885 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
886 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
887 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
888 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
889 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
890 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
891 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
892 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
893 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100894 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
895 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100897tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
898 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
899 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
900 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
901 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
902 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
903 being used for too long.
904
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100905tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
906 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
907 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
908 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
909 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
910 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
911 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
912 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
913 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
914 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
915 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
916 best value.
917
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100918tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
919 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
920 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
921 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
922 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
923 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
924
925tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
926 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
927 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
928 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
929 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313.3. Debugging
932--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200933
934debug
935 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
936 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
937 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
938 system startup.
939
940quiet
941 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
942 line argument "-q".
943
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009453.4. Userlists
946--------------
947It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
948http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
949it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
950
951userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100952 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100953 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
954
955group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100956 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100957 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
958 proceeded by "users" keyword.
959
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100960user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
961 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100962 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
963 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
965 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100966 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
967 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
968
969
970 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971 userlist L1
972 group G1 users tiger,scott
973 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
976 user scott insecure-password elgato
977 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100979 userlist L2
980 group G1
981 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100982
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
984 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
985 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
987 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200989
9903.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200991----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200992It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
993haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
994pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
995identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
996or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
997Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
998known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
999the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1000process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1001during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1002tables.
1003
1004peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001005 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001006 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1007
1008peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1011 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1012 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1013 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1014 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1015
1016 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1017 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1018
1019 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1020 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1021 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1022 across all peers.
1023
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001024 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001025 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001026 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1027 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1028 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001029
1030 backend mybackend
1031 mode tcp
1032 balance roundrobin
1033 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1034 stick on src
1035
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001036 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1037 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001038
1039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010404. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001041----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1044 - defaults <name>
1045 - frontend <name>
1046 - backend <name>
1047 - listen <name>
1048
1049A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1050its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1051section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001052section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
1054A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1055connections.
1056
1057A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1058to forward incoming connections.
1059
1060A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1061parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001063All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1064'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1065case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1066
1067Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1068logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1069proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1070However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1071name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1072
1073Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1074and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001075bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001076protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1077modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1078arbitrary criteria.
1079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010814.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1082--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001084The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1085limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1086they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1087limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001088marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001089option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001090and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1091with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1092specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001093
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001094
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001095 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1096------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1097acl - X X X
1098appsession - - X X
1099backlog X X X -
1100balance X - X X
1101bind - X X -
1102bind-process X X X X
1103block - X X X
1104capture cookie - X X -
1105capture request header - X X -
1106capture response header - X X -
1107clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001108compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1110cookie X - X X
1111default-server X - X X
1112default_backend X X X -
1113description - X X X
1114disabled X X X X
1115dispatch - - X X
1116enabled X X X X
1117errorfile X X X X
1118errorloc X X X X
1119errorloc302 X X X X
1120-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1121errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001122force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001123fullconn X - X X
1124grace X X X X
1125hash-type X - X X
1126http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001127http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001128http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001129http-request - X X X
1130id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001131ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001132log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001133maxconn X X X -
1134mode X X X X
1135monitor fail - X X -
1136monitor-net X X X -
1137monitor-uri X X X -
1138option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1139option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1140option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1141option allbackups (*) X - X X
1142option checkcache (*) X - X X
1143option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1144option contstats (*) X X X -
1145option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1146option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1147option forceclose (*) X X X X
1148-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1149option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001150option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001151option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001152option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1153option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1154option httpchk X - X X
1155option httpclose (*) X X X X
1156option httplog X X X X
1157option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001158option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001159option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001160option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001161option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1162option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1163option logasap (*) X X X -
1164option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001165option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001166option nolinger (*) X X X X
1167option originalto X X X X
1168option persist (*) X - X X
1169option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001170option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001171option smtpchk X - X X
1172option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1173option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1174option splice-request (*) X X X X
1175option splice-response (*) X X X X
1176option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1177option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1178-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1179option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1180option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1181option tcpka X X X X
1182option tcplog X X X X
1183option transparent (*) X - X X
1184persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1185rate-limit sessions X X X -
1186redirect - X X X
1187redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1188redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1189reqadd - X X X
1190reqallow - X X X
1191reqdel - X X X
1192reqdeny - X X X
1193reqiallow - X X X
1194reqidel - X X X
1195reqideny - X X X
1196reqipass - X X X
1197reqirep - X X X
1198reqisetbe - X X X
1199reqitarpit - X X X
1200reqpass - X X X
1201reqrep - X X X
1202-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1203reqsetbe - X X X
1204reqtarpit - X X X
1205retries X - X X
1206rspadd - X X X
1207rspdel - X X X
1208rspdeny - X X X
1209rspidel - X X X
1210rspideny - X X X
1211rspirep - X X X
1212rsprep - X X X
1213server - - X X
1214source X - X X
1215srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001216stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217stats auth X - X X
1218stats enable X - X X
1219stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001220stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001221stats realm X - X X
1222stats refresh X - X X
1223stats scope X - X X
1224stats show-desc X - X X
1225stats show-legends X - X X
1226stats show-node X - X X
1227stats uri X - X X
1228-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1229stick match - - X X
1230stick on - - X X
1231stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001232stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001233stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001234tcp-request connection - X X -
1235tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001236tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001237tcp-response content - - X X
1238tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001239timeout check X - X X
1240timeout client X X X -
1241timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1242timeout connect X - X X
1243timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1244timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1245timeout http-request X X X X
1246timeout queue X - X X
1247timeout server X - X X
1248timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1249timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001250timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001251transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001252unique-id-format X X X -
1253unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001254use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001255use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1257 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1261---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
1263This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1264
1265
1266acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1267 Declare or complete an access list.
1268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1269 no | yes | yes | yes
1270 Example:
1271 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1272 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1273 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
1277
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001278appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1279 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1282 no | no | yes | yes
1283 Arguments :
1284 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1285 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1286
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001287 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001288 checked in each cookie value.
1289
1290 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1291 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1292 milliseconds.
1293
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001294 request-learn
1295 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1296 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1297 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1298 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1299 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1300 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1301
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001302 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1303 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1304 data following this prefix.
1305
1306 Example :
1307 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1308
1309 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1310 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1311
1312 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1313 2 modes are currently supported :
1314 - path-parameters :
1315 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1316 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1317 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1318 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1319 - query-string :
1320 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1321 query string.
1322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1324 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1325 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1326 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001327 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1328 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1329 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001330 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1331 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1332
1333 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001335 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1336 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1337 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001339 Example :
1340 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1341
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001342 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1343 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
1345
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001346backlog <conns>
1347 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1349 yes | yes | yes | no
1350 Arguments :
1351 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1352 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001353 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001354
1355 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1356 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1357 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1358 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1359 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1360 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1361 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1362 backlog parameter.
1363
1364 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1365 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1366 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1367
1368 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1369
1370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001371balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001372balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001373 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1375 yes | no | yes | yes
1376 Arguments :
1377 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1378 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1379 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1380 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1381
1382 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1383 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1384 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1385 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001386 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1387 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1388 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1389 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1390 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1391 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1392 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1393 it, so that you don't worry.
1394
1395 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1396 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1397 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1398 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1399 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1400 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1401 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1402 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001403
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001404 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1405 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1406 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1407 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1408 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1409 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1410 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1411 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1412
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001413 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1414 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1415 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1416 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001417 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001418 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1419 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1420 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1421 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1422 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001423 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1424 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1425 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1426 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1427 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1428 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001430 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1431 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1432 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1433 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1434 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1435 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1436 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1437 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001439 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001440 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1441 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1442 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001443
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001444 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1445 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1446 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1447 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1448 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1449 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1450 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1451 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1452 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1453 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1454 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1455 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001457 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001458 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1459 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1460 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1461 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1462 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1463 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1464 URIs start with a leading "/".
1465
1466 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1467 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1468 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1469 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001472 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1473
1474 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001475 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1476 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1477 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1478 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1479 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1480 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1481 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1482 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1483 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1484 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1485 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1486 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1487 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1488 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1489 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1490 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1491 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1492 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1493 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001494
1495 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1496 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1497 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1498 server will receive the request.
1499
1500 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1501 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1502 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1503 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1504 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001505 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1506 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1507 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001509 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1510 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1511 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1512 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1513 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001515 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001516 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1517 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1518 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1519
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001520 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1521 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1522 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1523
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001524 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001525 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001526 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1527 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1528 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1529 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1530 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1531 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001533 used instead.
1534
1535 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1536 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1537 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1538 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1539
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001540 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1541 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1542 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1543
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001544 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001547 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1548 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001549
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001550 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001551 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001552
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001553 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1554 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1555 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556
1557 Examples :
1558 balance roundrobin
1559 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001560 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001561 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1562 balance hdr(host)
1563 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001564
1565 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1566 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001568 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001569 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1570 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1571 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1572 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1573
1574 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1575 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1576 defaults to 16 kB.
1577
1578 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1579 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1580
1581 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1582 Round Robin.
1583
1584 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1585 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1586 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1587 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1588
1589 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1590
1591 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001592 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001593 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1594 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1595 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001596
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001597 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1598 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599
1600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001601bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1602bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001603 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1605 no | yes | yes | no
1606 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001607 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1608 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1609 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1610 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001611 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001612 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1613 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1614 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1615 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1616 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1617 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1618 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001619
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001620 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1621 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001622 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1623 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1624 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001625 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1626 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1627 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1628 the range.
1629
1630 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1631 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1632 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1633 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1634 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1635 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1636 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001637 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001638 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001640 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1641 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1642 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1643 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1644 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1645 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1646 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1647 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1648
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001649 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1650 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1651 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1652 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001654 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1655 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1656 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1657 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1658 in a frontend.
1659
1660 Example :
1661 listen http_proxy
1662 bind :80,:443
1663 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001665
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001666 listen http_https_proxy
1667 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001668 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001669
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001670 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1671 bind ipv6@:80
1672 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1673 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1674
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001675 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001676 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677
1678
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001679bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001680 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1682 yes | yes | yes | yes
1683 Arguments :
1684 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1685 may be used to override a default value.
1686
1687 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1688 option may be combined with other numbers.
1689
1690 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1691 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1692 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1693 missing from all processes.
1694
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001695 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1696 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1697 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1698 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1699 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001700
1701 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1702 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1703 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1704 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1705 and 'even' instances.
1706
1707 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1708 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1709 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1710 32.
1711
1712 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1713 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1714
1715 Example :
1716 listen app_ip1
1717 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001718 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001719
1720 listen app_ip2
1721 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001722 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001723
1724 listen management
1725 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001726 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001727
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001728 listen management
1729 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1730 bind-process 1-4
1731
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001732 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1733
1734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001735block { if | unless } <condition>
1736 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1738 no | yes | yes | yes
1739
1740 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1741 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001742 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001743 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1745 "block" statements per instance.
1746
1747 Example:
1748 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1749 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1750 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1751 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001753 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
1755
1756capture cookie <name> len <length>
1757 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1759 no | yes | yes | no
1760 Arguments :
1761 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1762 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1763 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1764 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1765 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1766
1767 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1768 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1769 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1770 right if it exceeds <length>.
1771
1772 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1773 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1774 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1775 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1776
1777 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1778 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1779 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1780
1781 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1782 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1783 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001784 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1785 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1786 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787
1788 Example:
1789 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1790
1791 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001792 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793
1794
1795capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001796 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1798 no | yes | yes | no
1799 Arguments :
1800 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001801 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1803 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1804 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1805
1806 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1807 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1808 it exceeds <length>.
1809
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001810 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1812 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001813 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1814 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1815 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1816 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001817 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001818 environments to find where the request came from.
1819
1820 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1821 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1822 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1823 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001825 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1826 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1827 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1828 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1829 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
1831 Example:
1832 capture request header Host len 15
1833 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1834 capture request header Referrer len 15
1835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001836 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 about logging.
1838
1839
1840capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001841 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1843 no | yes | yes | no
1844 Arguments :
1845 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001846 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1848 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1849 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1850
1851 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1852 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1853 it exceeds <length>.
1854
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001855 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1857 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1858 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001859 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1860 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1861 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1862 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001864 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1865 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1866 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1867 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1868 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
1870 Example:
1871 capture response header Content-length len 9
1872 capture response header Location len 15
1873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001874 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875 about logging.
1876
1877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001878clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1881 yes | yes | yes | no
1882 Arguments :
1883 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1885 as explained at the top of this document.
1886
1887 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1888 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1889 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1890 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1891 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1892 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1893 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1894 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001895 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1897 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1898
1899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1900 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1901 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1902 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1903 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1904 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1905
1906 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1907 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1908
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001909 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1910 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001912compression algo <algorithm> ...
1913compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001914compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001915 Enable HTTP compression.
1916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1917 yes | yes | yes | yes
1918 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001919 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1920 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1921 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1922
1923 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001924 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001925 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1926 data.
1927
1928 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1929 support for zlib was built in.
1930
1931 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1932 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1933 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1934 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1935 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1936 in.
1937
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001938 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001939 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001940 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1941 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1942 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1943 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1944 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001945
1946 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1947 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1948 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1949 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1950 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001951 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1952 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1953 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1954 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1955 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1956 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001957
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001958 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001959 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1960 "Accept-Encoding" header
1961 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001962 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001963 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1964 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1965 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1966 "multipart"
1967 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1968 header
1969 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1970 and later
1971 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1972 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001973
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001974 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
1975 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001976
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001977 Examples :
1978 compression algo gzip
1979 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001981contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1984 yes | no | yes | yes
1985 Arguments :
1986 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1987 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1988 as explained at the top of this document.
1989
1990 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001991 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001992 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1994 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1995 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1996 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1997
1998 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1999 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2000 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2001 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2002 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2003 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2004
2005 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2006 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2007 instead.
2008
2009 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2010 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2011
2012
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002013cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002014 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2015 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 yes | no | yes | yes
2019 Arguments :
2020 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2021 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2022 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2023 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2024 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2025 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2026 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2027 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2028 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2029
2030 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2031 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2032 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2033 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2034 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2035 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2036 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2037 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2038 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2039 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2040 "insert" and "prefix".
2041
2042 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002043 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002044
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002045 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002046 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2047 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2048 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2049 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2050 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2051 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2052 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2053 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2054 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2055 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056
2057 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2058 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2059 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2060 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2061 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2062 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2063 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2064 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2065 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2066 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002067 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2068 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2069 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002071 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2072 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2073 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002074 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2075 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2076 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2077 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002078 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2079 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2080 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081
2082 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2083 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2084 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2085 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2086 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2087 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2088 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2089 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2090 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2091
2092 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2093 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2094 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2095 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2096 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2097 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2098 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2099 persistence cookie in the cache.
2100 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2101
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002102 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2103 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2104 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2105 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2106 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2107 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2108 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2109 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2110 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2111 they logout.
2112
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002113 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2114 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2115 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2116 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2117
2118 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2119 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2120 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2121 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2122 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2123 this attribute.
2124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002125 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002126 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002127 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2128 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2129 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2130 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2131 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2132 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002133
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002134 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2135 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2136 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2137 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2138 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2139 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2140 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2141 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2142 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2143 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2144 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2145 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2146 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2147 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2148 the site.
2149
2150 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2151 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2152 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2153 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2154 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2155 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2156 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2157 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2158 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2159 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2160 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2161 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2162 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2163 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2164 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2165 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2168 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2169 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2170 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172 Examples :
2173 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2174 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2175 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002176 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002178 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002179 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002182default-server [param*]
2183 Change default options for a server in a backend
2184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2185 yes | no | yes | yes
2186 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002187 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2188 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2189 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2190 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002191
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002192 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002193 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2194
2195 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002196
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198default_backend <backend>
2199 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 yes | yes | yes | no
2202 Arguments :
2203 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2204
2205 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2206 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2207 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2208 will catch all undetermined requests.
2209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210 Example :
2211
2212 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2213 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2214 default_backend dynamic
2215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002216 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002218
2219disabled
2220 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2222 yes | yes | yes | yes
2223 Arguments : none
2224
2225 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2226 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2227 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2228 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2229 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2230 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2231 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2232
2233 See also : "enabled"
2234
2235
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002236dispatch <address>:<port>
2237 Set a default server address
2238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2239 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002241
2242 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2243 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2244 during start-up.
2245
2246 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2247 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2248 possible with normal servers.
2249
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002250 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002251 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2252 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2253 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2254 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2255
2256 See also : "server"
2257
2258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259enabled
2260 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2262 yes | yes | yes | yes
2263 Arguments : none
2264
2265 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2266 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2267
2268 See also : "disabled"
2269
2270
2271errorfile <code> <file>
2272 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2274 yes | yes | yes | yes
2275 Arguments :
2276 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002277 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278
2279 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002280 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002281 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002282 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2283 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
2285 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2286 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2287 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2288
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002289 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002291 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2292 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2293 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2294 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2295
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002296 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2297 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2298 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2299 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2300 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2301 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2304 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2305 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002306 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2308
2309 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2310
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002311 Example :
2312 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2313 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2314 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2315
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002316
2317errorloc <code> <url>
2318errorloc302 <code> <url>
2319 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2321 yes | yes | yes | yes
2322 Arguments :
2323 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002324 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002325
2326 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2327 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2328 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2329 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2330 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2331
2332 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2333 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2334 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2335
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002336 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2337
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002338 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2339 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2340 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2341 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2342 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2343 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2344 request.
2345
2346 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2347
2348
2349errorloc303 <code> <url>
2350 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2352 yes | yes | yes | yes
2353 Arguments :
2354 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2355 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2356
2357 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2358 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2359 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2360 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2361 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2362
2363 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2364 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2365 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2366
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002367 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002369 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2370 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2371 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2372 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002373 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002374
2375 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2376
2377
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002378force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2379 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 no | yes | yes | yes
2382
2383 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2384 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2385 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2386 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2387 marked down for maintenance operations.
2388
2389 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2390 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2391 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2392 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2393 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2394 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2395 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2396 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2397 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2398
2399 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2400 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2401 is used.
2402
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002403 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002404 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002405
2406
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002407fullconn <conns>
2408 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2410 yes | no | yes | yes
2411 Arguments :
2412 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2413 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2414
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002415 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002416 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002417 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002418 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2419 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2420 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2421 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2422 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002423 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002424
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002425 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2426 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2427 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2428
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002429 Example :
2430 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2431 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2432 # connections.
2433 backend dynamic
2434 fullconn 10000
2435 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2436 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2437
2438 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2439
2440
2441grace <time>
2442 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002445 Arguments :
2446 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2447 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2448 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2449
2450 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2451 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002452 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002453 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2454
2455 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2456 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2457 simplify it.
2458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002460hash-type <method>
2461 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | no | yes | yes
2464 Arguments :
2465 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2466 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2467 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2468 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2469 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2470 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2471 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2472 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2473 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2474
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002475 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2476 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2477 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2478 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2479 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2480 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2481 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2482 this value.
2483
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002484 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2485 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2486 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2487 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2488 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2489 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2490 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2491 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2492 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2493 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2494 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2495 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2496 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2497
2498 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2499
2500 See also : "balance", "server"
2501
2502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503http-check disable-on-404
2504 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002506 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507 Arguments : none
2508
2509 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2510 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2511 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2512 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2513 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2514 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2515 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2516 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002517 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2518 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2519 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2520
2521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2522
2523
2524http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002525 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002527 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002528 Arguments :
2529 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2530 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002531 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002532 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2533 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2534 details on the supported keywords.
2535
2536 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2537 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2538 with the usual backslash ('\').
2539
2540 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2541 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2542 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2543 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2544 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2545
2546 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002547 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002548 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2549 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2550 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2551
2552 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002553 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002554 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2555 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2556 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2557 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2558
2559 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002560 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002561 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2562 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2563 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2564 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2565 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2566 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2567 trace).
2568
2569 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002570 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002571 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2572 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2573 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2574 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2575 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2576 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2577
2578 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2579 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2580 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2581 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2582 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2583 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2584 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2585 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2586
2587 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2588 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2589
2590 Examples :
2591 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002592 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002593
2594 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002595 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002596
2597 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002598 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002599
2600 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002601 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002603 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002604
2605
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002606http-check send-state
2607 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2609 yes | no | yes | yes
2610 Arguments : none
2611
2612 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2613 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2614 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2615 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2616 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2617
2618 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2619 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2620 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2621 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2622 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2623 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2624 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2625 checked in multiple backends.
2626
2627 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2628 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2629
2630 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2631 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2632 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2633 one fails.
2634
2635 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2636 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2637 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2638
2639 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2640 server's queue.
2641
2642 Example of a header received by the application server :
2643 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2644 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2645
2646 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2647
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002648http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002649 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002650 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002651 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2652
2653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 no | yes | yes | yes
2655
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002656 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2657 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2658 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2659 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2660 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002661
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002662 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2663 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2664 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2665
2666 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2667 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2668 are evaluated.
2669
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002670 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2671 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2672 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2673 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2674 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2675 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2676 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2677 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2678 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2679 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2680 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2681
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002682 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2683 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2684 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2685 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2686 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2687
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002688 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2689 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2690 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2691 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2692
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002693 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2694 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2695 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2696 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2697 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2698 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2699 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2700 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2701
2702 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2703 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2704 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2705 external users.
2706
2707 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2708
2709 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2710 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2711 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2712 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002713
2714 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002715 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2716 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2717 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002718
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002719 http-request allow if nagios
2720 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2721 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2722 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002723
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002724 Example:
2725 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002726 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002727
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002728 Example:
2729 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2730 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2731 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2732 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2733 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2734 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2735 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2736 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2737 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2738
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002739 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2740 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002741
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002742http-send-name-header [<header>]
2743 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2744
2745 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2746 yes | no | yes | yes
2747
2748 Arguments :
2749
2750 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2751
2752 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2753 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2754 is added with the header string proved.
2755
2756 See also : "server"
2757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002758id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002759 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2761 no | yes | yes | yes
2762 Arguments : none
2763
2764 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2765 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2766 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002767
2768
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002769ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2770 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 no | yes | yes | yes
2773
2774 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2775 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2776 and running).
2777
2778 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2779 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2780 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2781 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2782 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2783
2784 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2785 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2786
2787 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2788 "unless" condition is met.
2789
2790 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2791
2792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002793log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002794log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002795no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002796 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002799
2800 Prefix :
2801 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2802 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2803 prefix does not allow arguments.
2804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002805 Arguments :
2806 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2807 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2808 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2809 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2810 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2811 parameter.
2812
2813 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2814 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2815
2816 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2817 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2818 standard syslog port).
2819
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002820 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2821 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2822 standard syslog port).
2823
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002824 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2825 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2826 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2827 appropriately writeable).
2828
2829 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2830
2831 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2832 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2833 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2834
2835 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2836 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2837 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002838 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2839 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2840 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2841 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2842 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002843
2844 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2845
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002846 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2847 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2848 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002849
2850 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2851 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2852 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2853 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2854
2855 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2856 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002857
2858 Example :
2859 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002860 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2861 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002862
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002863log-format <string>
2864 Allows you to custom a log line.
2865
2866 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2867
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002868
2869maxconn <conns>
2870 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2872 yes | yes | yes | no
2873 Arguments :
2874 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2875 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2876 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2877 closes.
2878
2879 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2880 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2881 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2882 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2883 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2884 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2885 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2886 properly tuned.
2887
2888 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2889 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2890 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2891
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002892 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2893
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002894 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2895
2896
2897mode { tcp|http|health }
2898 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2900 yes | yes | yes | yes
2901 Arguments :
2902 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2903 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2904 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2905 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2906
2907 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2908 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2909 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2910 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2911 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2912
2913 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002914 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2915 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2916 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2917 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2918 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2919 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2920 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002922 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2923 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2924 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002925
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002926 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002927 defaults http_instances
2928 mode http
2929
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002930 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002933monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002934 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2936 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937 Arguments :
2938 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2939 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002940 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002941 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2942 backend and its backup.
2943
2944 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2945 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2946 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2947 servers in a list of backends.
2948
2949 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2950 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2951 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2952 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2953 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2954 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2955 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002956 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2957 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958
2959 Example:
2960 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002961 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2963 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2964 monitor-uri /site_alive
2965 monitor fail if site_dead
2966
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002967 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002968
2969
2970monitor-net <source>
2971 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2973 yes | yes | yes | no
2974 Arguments :
2975 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2976 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2977 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2978 followed by a mask.
2979
2980 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2981 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002982 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002983 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2984
2985 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2986 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2987 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2988 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002989 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2990 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2991 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002992
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002993 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2994 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2995 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2996 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2997 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2998 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003000 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3001 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003002
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003003 Example :
3004 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3005 frontend www
3006 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3007
3008 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3009
3010
3011monitor-uri <uri>
3012 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3014 yes | yes | yes | no
3015 Arguments :
3016 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3017 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3018
3019 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3020 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3021 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3022 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3023 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3024 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3025 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3026 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3027
3028 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3029 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3030 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3031 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3032 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3033 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3034
3035 Example :
3036 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3037 frontend www
3038 mode http
3039 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3040
3041 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003044option abortonclose
3045no option abortonclose
3046 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3048 yes | no | yes | yes
3049 Arguments : none
3050
3051 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3052 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3053 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3054 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003055 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003056 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3057 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3058 encountered while delivering the response.
3059
3060 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3061 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3062 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3063 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3064 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3065 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003066 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003067 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003068 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003069 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3070 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3071 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3072
3073 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3074 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3075 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3076 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3077 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3078 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3079 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3080 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003081 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003082
3083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3085
3086 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3087
3088
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003089option accept-invalid-http-request
3090no option accept-invalid-http-request
3091 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 yes | yes | yes | no
3094 Arguments : none
3095
3096 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3097 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3098 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3099 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3100 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3101 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3102 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3103 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003104 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3105 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3106 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3107 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3108 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3109 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003110
3111 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3112 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3113 been confirmed.
3114
3115 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3116 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003117 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3118 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003119 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3120
3121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3123
3124 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3125 stats socket.
3126
3127
3128option accept-invalid-http-response
3129no option accept-invalid-http-response
3130 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3132 yes | no | yes | yes
3133 Arguments : none
3134
3135 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3136 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3137 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3138 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3139 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3140 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3141 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3142 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3143 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3144
3145 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3146 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3147 been confirmed.
3148
3149 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3150 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3151 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3152 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3153
3154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3156
3157 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3158 stats socket.
3159
3160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003161option allbackups
3162no option allbackups
3163 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3165 yes | no | yes | yes
3166 Arguments : none
3167
3168 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3169 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3170 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3171 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3172 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3173 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3174 order between the backup servers anymore.
3175
3176 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3177 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3178
3179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3181
3182
3183option checkcache
3184no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003185 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 yes | no | yes | yes
3188 Arguments : none
3189
3190 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3191 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003192 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003193 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3194 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003195 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003196
3197 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003198 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003199 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003200 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3201 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003202 to the client are :
3203 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003204 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003205 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003206 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3207 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3208 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3209 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3210 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3211 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3212 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3213 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3214 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3215 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3216 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3217
3218 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003219 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003220 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003221 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003222 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3223
3224 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3225 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003226 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003227 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3228
3229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3231
3232
3233option clitcpka
3234no option clitcpka
3235 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3237 yes | yes | yes | no
3238 Arguments : none
3239
3240 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3241 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3242 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3243 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3244
3245 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3246 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3247 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3248 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3249
3250 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3251 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3252 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3253 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3254 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3255
3256 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3257
3258 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3259 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3260 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3261
3262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3264
3265 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3266
3267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003268option contstats
3269 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3271 yes | yes | yes | no
3272 Arguments : none
3273
3274 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3275 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3276 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3277 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3278 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3279 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3280 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3281
3282
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003283option dontlog-normal
3284no option dontlog-normal
3285 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 yes | yes | yes | no
3288 Arguments : none
3289
3290 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3291 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3292 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3293 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3294 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3295 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3296 logged.
3297
3298 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3299 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3300 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003302 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003303 logging.
3304
3305
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003306option dontlognull
3307no option dontlognull
3308 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 yes | yes | yes | no
3311 Arguments : none
3312
3313 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3314 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3315 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3316 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3317 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3318 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3319 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3320
3321 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3322 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3323 would not be logged.
3324
3325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003328 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003329
3330
3331option forceclose
3332no option forceclose
3333 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003335 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003336 Arguments : none
3337
3338 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3339 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3340 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3341 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3342 global session times in the logs.
3343
3344 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003345 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003346 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3347 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3348 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3349 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003350
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003351 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3352 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3353 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3354
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3357
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003358 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003359
3360
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003361option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003362 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | yes
3365 Arguments :
3366 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3367 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003368 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003369 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003370
3371 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3372 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3373 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3374 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3375 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3376 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3377 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003378 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3379 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3380 possible that the client has already brought one.
3381
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003382 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003383 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003384 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3385 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003386 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3387 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003388
3389 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3390 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3391 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3392 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3393 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3394 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3395 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3396
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003397 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3398 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3399 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3400 are under the control of the end-user.
3401
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003402 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003403 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3404 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003405 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3406 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3407 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003409 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3410 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3411 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3412 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3413 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003414
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003415 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003416 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3417 frontend www
3418 mode http
3419 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3420
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003421 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3422 backend www
3423 mode http
3424 option forwardfor header X-Client
3425
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003426 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3427 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003429
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003430option http-no-delay
3431no option http-no-delay
3432 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3434 yes | yes | yes | yes
3435 Arguments : none
3436
3437 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3438 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3439 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3440 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3441 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3442 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3443 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3444 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3445 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3446 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3447 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3448 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3449 affected.
3450
3451 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3452 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3453 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3454 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3455 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3456 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3457 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3458 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3459 latency environments.
3460
3461
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003462option http-pretend-keepalive
3463no option http-pretend-keepalive
3464 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
3467 Arguments : none
3468
3469 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3470 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3471 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3472 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3473 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3474 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3475 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3476 consider the response complete.
3477
3478 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3479 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3480 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3481 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3482 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3483 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3484
3485 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3486 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3487 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3488 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3489 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3490 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3491 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3492
3493 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3494 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003495 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003496 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3497 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003498
3499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3501
3502 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3503
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003504
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003505option http-server-close
3506no option http-server-close
3507 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3509 yes | yes | yes | yes
3510 Arguments : none
3511
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003512 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3513 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3514 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3515 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3516 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3517 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3518 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3519 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3520 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3521 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3522 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3523 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003524
3525 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3526 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3527 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3528 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003529 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3530 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003531
3532 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3533 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003534 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3535 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3536 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003537
3538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3540
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003541 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3542 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003543
3544
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003545option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003546no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003547 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | no
3550 Arguments : none
3551
3552 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3553 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3554 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3555 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3556 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3557 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3558 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3559
3560 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3561 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3562 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3563 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3564 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3565 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3566 request along its whole life.
3567
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003568 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3569 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3570 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3571 front of an existing proxy.
3572
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003573 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3574
3575 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3576 http-server-close".
3577
3578
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003579option httpchk
3580option httpchk <uri>
3581option httpchk <method> <uri>
3582option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3583 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | no | yes | yes
3586 Arguments :
3587 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3588 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3589 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3590 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3591 ones.
3592
3593 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3594 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3595 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3596
3597 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3598 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3599 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3600 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3601 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3602
3603 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3604 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3605 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3606 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3607 the lack of any response.
3608
3609 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3610
3611 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3612 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3613 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3614
3615 Examples :
3616 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3617 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3618 backend https_relay
3619 mode tcp
3620 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3621 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3622
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003623 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3624 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3625 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003626
3627
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003628option httpclose
3629no option httpclose
3630 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633 Arguments : none
3634
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003635 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3636 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3637 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3638 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3639 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3640 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3641 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003642
3643 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003644 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003645 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3646 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3647 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3648 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3649 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003650
3651 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3652 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3653 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003654 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3655 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003656
3657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3659
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003660 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3661 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003662
3663
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003664option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003665 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003668 Arguments :
3669 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3670 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3671 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3672 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3673 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003674
3675 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3676 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3677 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3678 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3679 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3680 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3681 ports.
3682
3683 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3684
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3687 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3688 by default.
3689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003690 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003691
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003692
3693option http_proxy
3694no option http_proxy
3695 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | yes | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : none
3699
3700 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3701 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3702 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3703 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3704 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3705
3706 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3707 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3708 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3709 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003710 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003711 be analyzed.
3712
3713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3715
3716 Example :
3717 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3718 backend direct_forward
3719 option httpclose
3720 option http_proxy
3721
3722 See also : "option httpclose"
3723
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003724
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003725option independent-streams
3726no option independent-streams
3727 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | yes
3730 Arguments : none
3731
3732 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3733 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3734 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3735 receive data or not.
3736
3737 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3738 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3739 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3740 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3741 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3742 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3743 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3744 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3745 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3746 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3747 socket buffers.
3748
3749 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3750 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3751 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3752 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3753 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3754
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003755 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3756 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3757 deprecated.
3758
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003759 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003760
3761
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003762option lb-agent-chk
3763 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | no | yes | yes
3766 Arguments : none
3767
3768 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3769 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3770 the following forms:
3771
3772 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3773 e.g. "75%"
3774
3775 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3776 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3777
3778 * The string "drain".
3779
3780 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3781 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3782 persistence.
3783
3784 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3785
3786 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3787
3788 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3789
3790 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3791
3792 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3793
3794 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3795
3796 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3797 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3798 useful in conjunction with this option.
3799
3800
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003801option ldap-check
3802 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 yes | no | yes | yes
3805 Arguments : none
3806
3807 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3808 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3809 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3810 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3811
3812 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3813 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3814
3815 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3816 configure it.
3817
3818 Example :
3819 option ldap-check
3820
3821 See also : "option httpchk"
3822
3823
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003824option log-health-checks
3825no option log-health-checks
3826 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3828 yes | no | yes | yes
3829 Arguments : none
3830
3831 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3832 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3833 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3834 of additional information is limited.
3835
3836 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3837 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3838
3839 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3840
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003841
3842option log-separate-errors
3843no option log-separate-errors
3844 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | yes | yes | no
3847 Arguments : none
3848
3849 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3850 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3851 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3852 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3853 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3854 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3855 provides very important information.
3856
3857 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3858 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3859 error logs.
3860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003861 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003862 logging.
3863
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003864
3865option logasap
3866no option logasap
3867 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | yes | yes | no
3870 Arguments : none
3871
3872 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3873 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3874 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3875 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3876 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3877 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3878 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003879 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003880 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3881 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3882
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003883 Examples :
3884 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3885 mode http
3886 option httplog
3887 option logasap
3888 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3889
3890 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3891 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3892 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3893 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003895 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003896 logging.
3897
3898
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003899option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3900 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003903 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003904 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3905 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003906
3907 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3908 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3909 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3910 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3911 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3912 in the MySQL table, like this :
3913
3914 USE mysql;
3915 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3916 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3917
3918 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3919 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3920 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3921 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3922 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3923 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3924 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3925 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3926 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3927
3928 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3929 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003930
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003931 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003932
3933 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3934 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3935 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3936 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3937 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3938 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3939
3940 See also: "option httpchk"
3941
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003942option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3943 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | no | yes | yes
3946 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003947 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3948 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003949
3950 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3951 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3952 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3953 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3954
3955 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003956
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003957option nolinger
3958no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003959 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003962 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003963
3964 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3965 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3966 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3967 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3968 connections.
3969
3970 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3971 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3972 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3973 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3974 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3975 this too.
3976
3977 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3978 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3979 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3980
3981 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3982 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3983 for servers.
3984
3985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3987
3988
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003989option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3990 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | yes | yes | yes
3993 Arguments :
3994 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3995 matching <network>
3996 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3997 header name.
3998
3999 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4000 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4001 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4002 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4003 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4004 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4005 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4006 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4007 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4008 possible that the client has already brought one.
4009
4010 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4011 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4012 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4013 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4014 header and requires different one.
4015
4016 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4017 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4018 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4019 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4020 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4021 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4022 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4023
4024 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4025 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4026 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4027 both are defined.
4028
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004029 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4030 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4031 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4032 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4033 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004034
4035 Examples :
4036 # Original Destination address
4037 frontend www
4038 mode http
4039 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4040
4041 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4042 backend www
4043 mode http
4044 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4045
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004046 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4047 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004048
4049
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004050option persist
4051no option persist
4052 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004055 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004056
4057 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4058 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4059 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4060 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4061 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4062 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4063 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4064 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4065 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4066 redirected to another valid server.
4067
4068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4070
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004071 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004072
4073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004074option redispatch
4075no option redispatch
4076 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004079 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004080
4081 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4082 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4083 be able to access the service anymore.
4084
4085 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4086 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4087
4088 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4089 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4090 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004092 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4093 "redisp" keywords.
4094
4095 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4096 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4097
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004098 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004099
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004100
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004101option redis-check
4102 Use redis health checks for server testing
4103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 yes | no | yes | yes
4105 Arguments : none
4106
4107 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4108 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4109 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4110 find the "+PONG" response message.
4111
4112 Example :
4113 option redis-check
4114
4115 See also : "option httpchk"
4116
4117
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004118option smtpchk
4119option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4120 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004123 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004124 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4125 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4126 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4127
4128 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4129 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4130 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4131
4132 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4133 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4134 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4135 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4136 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4137 dead server.
4138
4139 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4140 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4141 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4142 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4143
4144 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4145 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4146 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4147 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4148 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4149
4150 Example :
4151 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4152
4153 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004156option socket-stats
4157no option socket-stats
4158
4159 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | no
4162
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004166option splice-auto
4167no option splice-auto
4168 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | yes | yes | yes
4171 Arguments : none
4172
4173 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4174 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4175 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4176 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004177 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004178 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4179 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4180 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4181 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4182
4183 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4184 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4185 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4186 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4187 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4188 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4189 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4190 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4191 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4192 keyword.
4193
4194 Example :
4195 option splice-auto
4196
4197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4199
4200 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4201 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4202
4203
4204option splice-request
4205no option splice-request
4206 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 yes | yes | yes | yes
4209 Arguments : none
4210
4211 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004212 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004213 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4214 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4215 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4216 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4217
4218 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4219
4220 Example :
4221 option splice-request
4222
4223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4225
4226 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4227 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4228
4229
4230option splice-response
4231no option splice-response
4232 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4234 yes | yes | yes | yes
4235 Arguments : none
4236
4237 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004238 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004239 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4240 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4241 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4242 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4243
4244 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4245
4246 Example :
4247 option splice-response
4248
4249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4251
4252 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4253 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4254
4255
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004256option srvtcpka
4257no option srvtcpka
4258 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | no | yes | yes
4261 Arguments : none
4262
4263 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4264 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4265 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4266 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4267
4268 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4269 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4270 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4271 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4272
4273 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4274 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4275 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4276 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4277 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4278
4279 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4280
4281 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4282 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4283 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4284
4285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4287
4288 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4289
4290
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004291option ssl-hello-chk
4292 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 yes | no | yes | yes
4295 Arguments : none
4296
4297 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4298 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4299 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4300 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4301 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4302 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4303 hello message.
4304
4305 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4306 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4307 messages, which is appreciable.
4308
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004309 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4310 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4311 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004312
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004313 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4314
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004315
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004316option tcp-smart-accept
4317no option tcp-smart-accept
4318 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | yes | yes | no
4321 Arguments : none
4322
4323 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4324 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4325 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4326 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4327 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4328 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4329
4330 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4331 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4332 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4333 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4334
4335 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4336 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4337 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4338 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4339
4340 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4341 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4342 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4343
4344 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4345 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4346 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4347
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004348 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4349
4350
4351option tcp-smart-connect
4352no option tcp-smart-connect
4353 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 yes | no | yes | yes
4356 Arguments : none
4357
4358 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4359 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4360 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4361 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4362 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4363
4364 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4365 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4366 complex.
4367
4368 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4369 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4370 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4371
4372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4374
4375 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4376
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004377
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004378option tcpka
4379 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | yes | yes | yes
4382 Arguments : none
4383
4384 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4385 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4386 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4387 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4388
4389 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4390 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4391 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4392 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4393
4394 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4395 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4396 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4397 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4398 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4399
4400 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4401
4402 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4403 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4404 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4405 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4406 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4407 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4408 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4409 backends.
4410
4411 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4412
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004413
4414option tcplog
4415 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | yes | yes | yes
4418 Arguments : none
4419
4420 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4421 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4422 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4423 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4424 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4425 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4426 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4427 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4428
4429 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004431 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004432
4433
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004434option transparent
4435no option transparent
4436 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004438 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004439 Arguments : none
4440
4441 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4442 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4443 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4444 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4445 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4446 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4447 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4448 appropriate server.
4449
4450 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4451 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4452
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004453 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004454 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004456
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004457persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004458persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004459 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | no | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004464 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4465 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004466
4467 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4468 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4469 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4470 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4471 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4472 forwarded to this server.
4473
4474 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4475 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4476 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004477 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004478 a single "listen" section.
4479
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004480 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4481 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4482 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4483
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004484 Example :
4485 listen tse-farm
4486 bind :3389
4487 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4488 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4489 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4490 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4491 persist rdp-cookie
4492 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004493 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004494 balance rdp-cookie
4495 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4496 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4497
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004498 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4499 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004500
4501
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004502rate-limit sessions <rate>
4503 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4505 yes | yes | yes | no
4506 Arguments :
4507 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4508 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4509
4510 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4511 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4512 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4513 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4514 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4515 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4516
4517 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4518 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4519 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4520 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4521
4522 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4523 listen smtp
4524 mode tcp
4525 bind :25
4526 rate-limit sessions 10
4527 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4528
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004529 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4530 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4531 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004532
4533 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4534
4535
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004536redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4537redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4538redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004539 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 no | yes | yes | yes
4542
4543 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004544 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004545
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004546 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004547 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4548 the HTTP "Location" header.
4549
4550 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4551 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4552 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4553 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4554 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4555 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4556
4557 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4558 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4559 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4560 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4561 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4562 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4563 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4564 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4565 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004566
4567 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4568 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4569 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4570 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4571 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4572 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4573 location with a GET method.
4574
4575 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4576 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4577
4578 - "drop-query"
4579 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4580 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4581 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4582 with a location-type redirect.
4583
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004584 - "append-slash"
4585 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4586 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4587 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4588 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4589
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004590 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4591 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4592 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4593 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4594 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4595 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4596 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4597
4598 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4599 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4600 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4601 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4602 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4603 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4604 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004605
4606 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4607 acl clear dst_port 80
4608 acl secure dst_port 8080
4609 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004610 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004611 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004612 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4613
4614 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004615 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4616 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4617 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004618 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004619
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004620 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4621 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4622 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4623
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004624 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004625 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004627 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004628
4629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004630redisp (deprecated)
4631redispatch (deprecated)
4632 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004635 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004636
4637 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4638 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4639 be able to access the service anymore.
4640
4641 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4642 redistribute them to a working server.
4643
4644 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4645 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4646 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004648 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4649 "option redispatch" instead.
4650
4651 See also : "option redispatch"
4652
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004653
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004654reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004655 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 no | yes | yes | yes
4658 Arguments :
4659 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4660 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004661 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004666 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4667 the last header of an HTTP request.
4668
4669 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4670 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4671 responses.
4672
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004673 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4674 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4675 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4676
4677 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4678 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004679
4680
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004681reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4682reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4685 no | yes | yes | yes
4686 Arguments :
4687 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4688 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4689 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4690 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4691 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4692 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4693 ignores case.
4694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004698 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4699 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4700 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4701 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004702 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004703
4704 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4705 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4706
4707 Example :
4708 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4709 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4710 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4711
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004712 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4713 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714
4715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004716reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4717reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004718 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 no | yes | yes | yes
4721 Arguments :
4722 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4723 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4724 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4725 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4726 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4727 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4728
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004729 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4730 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4731
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004732 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4733 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4734 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4735 next servers.
4736
4737 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4738 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4739 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4740
4741 Example :
4742 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4743 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4744 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4745
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004746 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4747 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004748
4749
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004750reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4751reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004752 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 no | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments :
4756 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4757 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4758 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4759 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4760 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4761 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4762 case.
4763
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004764 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4765 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4766
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004767 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4768 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4769 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4770 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004771 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004772
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004773 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004774 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004775 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004776
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004777 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4778 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4779
4780 Example :
4781 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4782 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4783 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4784
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004785 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4786 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787
4788
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004789reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4790reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004791 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 no | yes | yes | yes
4794 Arguments :
4795 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4796 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4797 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4798 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4799 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4800 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4801 case.
4802
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004803 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4804 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4805
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004806 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4807 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4808 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4809 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4810
4811 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4812 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4813
4814 Example :
4815 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4816 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4817 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4818 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4819
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004820 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4821 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004822
4823
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004824reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4825reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004826 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 no | yes | yes | yes
4829 Arguments :
4830 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4831 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4832 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4833 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4834 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4835 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4836
4837 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4838 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4839 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4840 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004841 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004842
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004843 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4844 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4845
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004846 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4847 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4848 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4849
4850 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4851 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4852 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4853 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4854 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4855
4856 Example :
4857 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004858 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004859 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4860 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4861
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004862 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4863 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004864
4865
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004866reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4867reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004868 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 no | yes | yes | yes
4871 Arguments :
4872 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4873 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4874 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4875 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4876 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4877 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4878 ignores case.
4879
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004880 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4881 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4882
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004883 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4884 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004885 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4886 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4887 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004888 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4889 not set.
4890
4891 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4892 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4893 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4894 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4895 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4896
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004897 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004898 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4899 # block all others.
4900 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4901 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4902
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004903 # block bad guys
4904 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4905 reqitarpit . if badguys
4906
4907 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4908 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004909
4910
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004911retries <value>
4912 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | no | yes | yes
4915 Arguments :
4916 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4917 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4918 default value is 3.
4919
4920 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4921 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4922 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4923
4924 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4925 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4926
4927 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4928 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4929
4930 See also : "option redispatch"
4931
4932
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004933rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004934 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4936 no | yes | yes | yes
4937 Arguments :
4938 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4939 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004940 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004941
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004942 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4943 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4944
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004945 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4946 the last header of an HTTP response.
4947
4948 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4949 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4950 responses.
4951
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004952 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4953 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004954
4955
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004956rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4957rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004958 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 no | yes | yes | yes
4961 Arguments :
4962 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4963 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4964 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4965 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4966 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4967 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4968 ignores case.
4969
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004970 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4971 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4972
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004973 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4974 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004975 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004976 client.
4977
4978 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4979 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4980 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4981
4982 Example :
4983 # remove the Server header from responses
4984 reqidel ^Server:.*
4985
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004986 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4987 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004988
4989
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004990rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4991rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004992 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 no | yes | yes | yes
4995 Arguments :
4996 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4997 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4998 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4999 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5000 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5001 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5002 ignores case.
5003
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005004 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5005 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5006
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005007 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5008 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5009 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5010 case-sensitive.
5011
5012 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005013 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5014 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5015 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005016
5017 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5018 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5019
5020 Example :
5021 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5022 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5023
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005024 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5025 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005026
5027
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005028rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5029rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005030 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 no | yes | yes | yes
5033 Arguments :
5034 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5035 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5036 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5037 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5038 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5039 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5040 ignores case.
5041
5042 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5043 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5044 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5045 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005046 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005047
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005048 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5049 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5050
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005051 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5052 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5053 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5054
5055 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5056 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5057 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5058 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5059 are not case-sensitive.
5060
5061 Example :
5062 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5063 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5064
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005065 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5066 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005067
5068
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005069server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005070 Declare a server in a backend
5071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5072 no | no | yes | yes
5073 Arguments :
5074 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005075 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005076 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005077
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005078 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5079 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5080 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5081 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005082 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5083 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5084 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5085 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5086 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005087 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5088 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5089 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5090 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5091 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5092 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5093 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005095 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005096 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5097 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5098 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5099 adding this value to the client's port.
5100
5101 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5102 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005104
5105 Examples :
5106 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5107 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005108 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005109
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005110 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5111 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005112
5113
5114source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005115source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005116source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005117 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5119 yes | no | yes | yes
5120 Arguments :
5121 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5122 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005123
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005124 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005125 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5126 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5127 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5128 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5129 supported prefixes are :
5130 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5131 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5132 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005133
5134 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5135 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005136 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5137 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5138 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005139
5140 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5141 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5142 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5143 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5144 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5145 <addr>.
5146
5147 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5148 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5149 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5150 port.
5151
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005152 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5153 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5154 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5155 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005156 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005157 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5158 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5159 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5160 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5161 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5162 HTTP header.
5163
5164 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5165 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005166 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005167 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5168 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5169 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5170 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5171 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5172 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5173 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5174
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005175 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5176 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5177 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5178 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5179 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5180 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5181
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005182 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5183 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5184 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5185 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5186
5187 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5188 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5189 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5190 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5191 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5192 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5193
5194 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5195 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5196 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5197 there are two methods :
5198
5199 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5200 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5201 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5202 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5203 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5204 of the client ranges may be used.
5205
5206 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5207 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5208 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5209 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5210 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5211 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5212 same session.
5213
5214 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5215 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5216 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5217 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5218 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5219 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5220
5221 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5222 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5223 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005224 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005225
5226 Examples :
5227 backend private
5228 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5229 source 192.168.1.200
5230
5231 backend transparent_ssl1
5232 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5233 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5234
5235 backend transparent_ssl2
5236 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5237 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5238 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5239
5240 backend transparent_ssl3
5241 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5242 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5243 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5244
5245 backend transparent_smtp
5246 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5247 # with Tproxy version 4.
5248 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5249
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005250 backend transparent_http
5251 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5252 # proxy.
5253 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005255 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005256 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005258
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005259srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5260 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5262 yes | no | yes | yes
5263 Arguments :
5264 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5265 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5266 as explained at the top of this document.
5267
5268 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5269 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5270 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5271 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5272 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5273 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5274 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5275
5276 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5277 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5278 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5279 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5280 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005281 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005282 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005283 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005284
5285 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5286 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5287 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5288 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5289 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5290 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5291
5292 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5293 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5294
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005295 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5296 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005297
5298
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005299stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5300 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 no | no | yes | yes
5303
5304 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5305 matched.
5306
5307 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5308 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5309
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005310 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5311 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5312 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5313
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005314 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5315 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5316 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5317 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005318
5319 Example :
5320 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5321 backend stats_localhost
5322 stats enable
5323 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5324
5325 Example :
5326 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5327 backend stats_auth
5328 stats enable
5329 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5330 stats admin if TRUE
5331
5332 Example :
5333 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5334 userlist stats-auth
5335 group admin users admin
5336 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5337 group readonly users haproxy
5338 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5339
5340 backend stats_auth
5341 stats enable
5342 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5343 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5344 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5345 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5346
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005347 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5348 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5349 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005350
5351
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005352stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5353 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356 Arguments :
5357 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5358
5359 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5360
5361 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5362 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5363 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5364 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5365 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5366 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5367
5368 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5369 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5370 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005371 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005372
5373 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5374 report using "stats scope".
5375
5376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5378 unobvious parameters.
5379
5380 Example :
5381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5382 backend public_www
5383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5384 stats enable
5385 stats hide-version
5386 stats scope .
5387 stats uri /admin?stats
5388 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5391
5392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5393 backend private_monitoring
5394 stats enable
5395 stats uri /admin?stats
5396 stats refresh 5s
5397
5398 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5399
5400
5401stats enable
5402 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 yes | no | yes | yes
5405 Arguments : none
5406
5407 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5408 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5409 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5410 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5411 - stats auth : no authentication
5412 - stats scope : no restriction
5413
5414 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5415 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5416 unobvious parameters.
5417
5418 Example :
5419 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5420 backend public_www
5421 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5422 stats enable
5423 stats hide-version
5424 stats scope .
5425 stats uri /admin?stats
5426 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5427 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5428 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5429
5430 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5431 backend private_monitoring
5432 stats enable
5433 stats uri /admin?stats
5434 stats refresh 5s
5435
5436 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5437
5438
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005439stats hide-version
5440 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005443 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005444
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005445 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5446 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5447 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5448 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5449 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5450 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005452 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5453 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5454 unobvious parameters.
5455
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005456 Example :
5457 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5458 backend public_www
5459 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005460 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005461 stats hide-version
5462 stats scope .
5463 stats uri /admin?stats
5464 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5465 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5466 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005467
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005468 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5469 backend private_monitoring
5470 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005471 stats uri /admin?stats
5472 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005473
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005474 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005475
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005476
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005477stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5479 Access control for statistics
5480
5481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5482 no | no | yes | yes
5483
5484 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5485 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5486 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5487 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5488 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5489 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5490
5491 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5492 instance.
5493
5494 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5495 about ACL usage.
5496
5497
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005498stats realm <realm>
5499 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5501 yes | no | yes | yes
5502 Arguments :
5503 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5504 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5505 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5506
5507 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5508 using a backslash ('\').
5509
5510 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5511 only related to authentication.
5512
5513 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5514 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5515 unobvious parameters.
5516
5517 Example :
5518 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5519 backend public_www
5520 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5521 stats enable
5522 stats hide-version
5523 stats scope .
5524 stats uri /admin?stats
5525 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5526 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5527 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5528
5529 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5530 backend private_monitoring
5531 stats enable
5532 stats uri /admin?stats
5533 stats refresh 5s
5534
5535 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5536
5537
5538stats refresh <delay>
5539 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 yes | no | yes | yes
5542 Arguments :
5543 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5544 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5545 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5546 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5547 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5548 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5549
5550 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5551 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5552 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5553 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5554
5555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5557 unobvious parameters.
5558
5559 Example :
5560 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5561 backend public_www
5562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5563 stats enable
5564 stats hide-version
5565 stats scope .
5566 stats uri /admin?stats
5567 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5568 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5569 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5570
5571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5572 backend private_monitoring
5573 stats enable
5574 stats uri /admin?stats
5575 stats refresh 5s
5576
5577 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5578
5579
5580stats scope { <name> | "." }
5581 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 yes | no | yes | yes
5584 Arguments :
5585 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5586 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5587 section in which the statement appears.
5588
5589 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5590 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5591 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5592 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5593 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5594 exists.
5595
5596 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5597 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5598 unobvious parameters.
5599
5600 Example :
5601 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5602 backend public_www
5603 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5604 stats enable
5605 stats hide-version
5606 stats scope .
5607 stats uri /admin?stats
5608 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5609 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5610 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5611
5612 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5613 backend private_monitoring
5614 stats enable
5615 stats uri /admin?stats
5616 stats refresh 5s
5617
5618 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005620
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005621stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005622 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005626 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005627 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5628
5629 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5630 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5631
5632 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5633 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005634 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005635
5636 Example :
5637 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5638 backend private_monitoring
5639 stats enable
5640 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5641 stats uri /admin?stats
5642 stats refresh 5s
5643
5644 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5645 global section.
5646
5647
5648stats show-legends
5649 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5650 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5651 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5652 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5653 - IP (socket, server)
5654 - cookie (backend, server)
5655
5656 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5657 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005658 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005659
5660 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5661
5662
5663stats show-node [ <name> ]
5664 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | no | yes | yes
5667 Arguments:
5668 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5669 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5670
5671 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5672 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005673 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005674
5675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5677 unobvious parameters.
5678
5679 Example:
5680 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5681 backend private_monitoring
5682 stats enable
5683 stats show-node Europe-1
5684 stats uri /admin?stats
5685 stats refresh 5s
5686
5687 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5688 section.
5689
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005690
5691stats uri <prefix>
5692 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 yes | no | yes | yes
5695 Arguments :
5696 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5697 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5698 query string.
5699
5700 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5701 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5702 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5703 possible to reach it in the application.
5704
5705 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005706 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005707 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5708 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5709 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5710 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5711
5712 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5713 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5714 an address or a port to statistics only.
5715
5716 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5717 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5718 unobvious parameters.
5719
5720 Example :
5721 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5722 backend public_www
5723 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5724 stats enable
5725 stats hide-version
5726 stats scope .
5727 stats uri /admin?stats
5728 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5729 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5730 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5731
5732 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5733 backend private_monitoring
5734 stats enable
5735 stats uri /admin?stats
5736 stats refresh 5s
5737
5738 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5739
5740
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005741stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5742 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005744 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005745
5746 Arguments :
5747 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5748 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5749 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5750 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5751
5752 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5753 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5754 the "stick-table" statement.
5755
5756 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5757 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5758 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5759 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5760 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5761
5762 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5763 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5764 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5765 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5766 transformation rules.
5767
5768 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5769 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5770 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5771 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5772 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5773 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5774 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5775
5776 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5777 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5778 ACL based conditions.
5779
5780 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5781 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5782 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5783 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5784
5785 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5786 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5787 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5788 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5789
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005790 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5791 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5792 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5793
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005794 Example :
5795 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5796 # last 30 minutes
5797 backend pop
5798 mode tcp
5799 balance roundrobin
5800 stick store-request src
5801 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5802 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5803 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5804
5805 backend smtp
5806 mode tcp
5807 balance roundrobin
5808 stick match src table pop
5809 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5810 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5811
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005812 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5813 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005814
5815
5816stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5817 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 no | no | yes | yes
5820
5821 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5822 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5823 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5824 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5825
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005826 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5827 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5828 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5829
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005830 Examples :
5831 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005832 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005833
5834 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5835 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5836 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5837
5838
5839 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5840 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5841 backend http
5842 mode http
5843 balance roundrobin
5844 stick on src table https
5845 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5846 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5847 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5848
5849 backend https
5850 mode tcp
5851 balance roundrobin
5852 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5853 stick on src
5854 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5855 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5856
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005857 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005858
5859
5860stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5861 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 no | no | yes | yes
5864
5865 Arguments :
5866 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5867 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5868 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5869 server is selected.
5870
5871 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5872 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5873 the "stick-table" statement.
5874
5875 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5876 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5877 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5878 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5879 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5880 address.
5881
5882 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5883 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5884 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5885 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5886 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5887 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5888 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5889 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5890 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5891 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5892
5893 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5894 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5895 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5896 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5897 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5898 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5899 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5900
5901 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5902 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5903 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5904 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5905
5906 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5907 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5908 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5909 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5910 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5911 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5912 another protocol or access method.
5913
5914 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5915 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5916 the request.
5917
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005918 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5919 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5920 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5921
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005922 Example :
5923 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5924 # last 30 minutes
5925 backend pop
5926 mode tcp
5927 balance roundrobin
5928 stick store-request src
5929 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5930 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5931 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5932
5933 backend smtp
5934 mode tcp
5935 balance roundrobin
5936 stick match src table pop
5937 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5938 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5939
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005940 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5941 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005942
5943
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005944stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005945 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5946 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005947 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005949 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005950
5951 Arguments :
5952 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5953 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5954 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5955 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5956
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005957 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5958 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5959 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5960 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5961
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005962 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5963 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5964 instance.
5965
5966 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5967 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5968 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5969 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5970 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5971 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005972 to 32 characters.
5973
5974 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5975 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5976 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5977 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5978 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5979 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005980
5981 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005982 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5983 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005984 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5985 increase.
5986
5987 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005988 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5989 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5990 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005991
5992 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5993 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5994 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5995 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5996 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5997 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5998 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5999 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6000 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6001 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6002 parameter (see below).
6003
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006004 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6005 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6006 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6007 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6008 soft restart.
6009
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006010 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6011
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006012 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6013 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6014 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6015 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6016 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006017 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006018 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6019 if not expiration delay is specified.
6020
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006021 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6022 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6023 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6024 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006025 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6026 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6027 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6028 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6029 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6030 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6031 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6032 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6033 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6034 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6035 types and their arguments.
6036
6037 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6038 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6039 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6040 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6041
6042 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6043 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6044 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6045 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6046
6047 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6048 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6049 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6050 they were received.
6051
6052 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6053 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6054 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6055 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6056 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6057
6058 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6059 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6060 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6061 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6062 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6063
6064 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6065 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6066 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6067
6068 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6069 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6070 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6071 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6072 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6073
6074 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6075 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6076 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6077 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6078 the client side.
6079
6080 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6081 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6082 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6083 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6084 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6085 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6086 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6087
6088 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6089 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6090 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6091 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6092 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6093 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6094 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6095
6096 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6097 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6098 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6099 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6100 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6101 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6102
6103 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6104 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6105 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6106 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6107
6108 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6109 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6110 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6111 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6112 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6113 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6114 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6115 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6116 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6117 recommended for better fairness.
6118
6119 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6120 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6121 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6122 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6123
6124 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6125 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6126 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6127 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6128 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6129 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6130 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6131 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6132 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6133 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006134
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006135 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6136 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006137 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6138 reference it.
6139
6140 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6141 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6142 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6143 as an exclusive stickiness.
6144
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006145 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6146 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6147 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6148 something that can be ignored.
6149
6150 Example:
6151 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6152 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6153 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6154 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6155
6156 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006157 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006158
6159
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006160stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6161 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 no | no | yes | yes
6164
6165 Arguments :
6166 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6167 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6168 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6169 server is selected.
6170
6171 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6172 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6173 the "stick-table" statement.
6174
6175 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6176 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6177 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6178 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6179
6180 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6181 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6182 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6183 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6184 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6185 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006186 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006187 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6188 rules.
6189
6190 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6191 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6192 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6193 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6194 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6195 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6196 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6197
6198 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6199 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6200 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6201 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6202
6203 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6204 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6205 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6206 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6207 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6208 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6209 another protocol or access method.
6210
6211 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6212
6213 Example :
6214 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6215 backend https
6216 mode tcp
6217 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006218 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006219 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006220
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006221 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6222 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6223
6224 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6225 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6226 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6227
6228 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6229 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006230
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006231 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6232 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6233 # at offset 44.
6234
6235 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6236 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6237
6238 # Learn on response if server hello.
6239 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006240
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006241 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6242 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6243
6244 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6245 extraction.
6246
6247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006248tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6249 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6251 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006252 Arguments :
6253 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6254 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6255 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006257 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006258
6259 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6260 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006261 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6262 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6263 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6264 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6265 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6266 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006267
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006268 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6269 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6270 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6271 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006273 Three types of actions are supported :
6274 - accept :
6275 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6276 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6277 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006279 - reject :
6280 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6281 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6282 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6283 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6284 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6285 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6286 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6287 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6288 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6289 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6290 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6291 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006293 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6294 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6295 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6296 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6297 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6298 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6299 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6300 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6301 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006303 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006304 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6305 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6306 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6307 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6308 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6309 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006311 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6312 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6313 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6314 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006316 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6317 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6318 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6319 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6320 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006321 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6322 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6323 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6324 layer7 information is extracted.
6325
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006326 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6327 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6328 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6329 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6330 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006332 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6333 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6334 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006335
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006336 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6337 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6338 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006339
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006340 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006341 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006342 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006343
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006344 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6345 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6346 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006348 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6349 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6350 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006351
6352 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6353
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006354 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006355
6356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006357tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6358 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006360 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006361 Arguments :
6362 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6363 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6364 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006366 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006368 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6369 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6370 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6371 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6372 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006374 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6375 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6376 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6377 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6378 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6379 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6380 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6381 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6382 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006383
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006384 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6385 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6386 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6387 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006389 Three types of actions are supported :
6390 - accept :
6391 - reject :
6392 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006394 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6395 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006397 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6398 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6399 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006400 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6401 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6402 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6403 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6404 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6405 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006407 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006408 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6409 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006411 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006412 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6413 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6414 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6415 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6416 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006417
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006418 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6419 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6420 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6421 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6422
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006423 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006424 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6425 # and reject everything else.
6426 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6427 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006428 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006429 tcp-request content reject
6430
6431 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006432 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6433 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6434 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006435 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006436
6437 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6438 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6439 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006440 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006441 tcp-request content reject
6442
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006443 Example:
6444 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6445 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6446 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6447
6448 Example:
6449 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6450 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6451 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006453 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6454 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6455
6456 frontend http
6457 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6458 # protecting all our sites
6459 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6460 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6461 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6462 ...
6463 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6464
6465 backend http_dynamic
6466 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6467 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6468 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6469 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01006470 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006471 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6472 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006474 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006475
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006476 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006477
6478
6479tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6480 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006482 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006483 Arguments :
6484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6486 as explained at the top of this document.
6487
6488 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6489 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6490 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6491 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6492 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6493
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006494 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6495 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6496 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6497 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6498
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006499 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6500 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006501 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006502 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006503 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6504 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6505 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6506 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006507
6508 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6509 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6510 it pass through unaffected.
6511
6512 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6513 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6514 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006515 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006516 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6517 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006518 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6519 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6520 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006521
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006522 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006523 "timeout client".
6524
6525
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006526tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6527 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6529 no | no | yes | yes
6530 Arguments :
6531 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6532 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6533 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6534
6535 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6536
6537 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6538 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6539 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6540 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006541 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006542
6543 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6544
6545 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6546 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6547 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6548 inserted.
6549
6550 Two types of actions are supported :
6551 - accept :
6552 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6553 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6554 the rules evaluation.
6555
6556 - reject :
6557 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6558 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006559 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006560
6561 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6562 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6563 for changing the default action to a reject.
6564
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006565 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6566 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6567 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6568 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006569 period.
6570
6571 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6572
6573 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6574
6575
6576tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6577 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 no | no | yes | yes
6580 Arguments :
6581 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6582 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6583 as explained at the top of this document.
6584
6585 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6586
6587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006588timeout check <timeout>
6589 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6590 established.
6591
6592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6593 yes | no | yes | yes
6594 Arguments:
6595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6597 as explained at the top of this document.
6598
6599 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6600 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6601 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6602 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006603 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6604 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6605 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006606
6607 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6608 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6609
6610 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6611 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006612 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006613
6614 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6615 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6616 forget about it.
6617
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006618 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6619 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006620
6621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006622timeout client <timeout>
6623timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6624 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6626 yes | yes | yes | no
6627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6630 as explained at the top of this document.
6631
6632 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6633 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6634 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6635 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6636 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6637 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6638 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6639 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006640 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006641 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006642 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6643 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6644 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006645
6646 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6647 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6648 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6649 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6650 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6651 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6652
6653 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6654 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6655 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6656
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006657 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006658
6659
6660timeout connect <timeout>
6661timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6662 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | no | yes | yes
6665 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006666 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006667 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6668 as explained at the top of this document.
6669
6670 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006671 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006672 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006673 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006674 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6675 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006676
6677 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6678 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6679 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6680 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6681 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6682 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6683
6684 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6685 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6686 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6687
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006688 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6689 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006690
6691
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006692timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6693 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | yes | yes | yes
6696 Arguments :
6697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6699 as explained at the top of this document.
6700
6701 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6702 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6703 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6704 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6705 once the request has started to present itself.
6706
6707 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6708 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6709 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6710 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6711 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6712
6713 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6714 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6715 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6716 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6717
6718 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6719 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6720 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6721 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6722 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006723 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006724
6725 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6726 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6727 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6728 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6729
6730 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6731
6732
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006733timeout http-request <timeout>
6734 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006737 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006738 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006739 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6740 as explained at the top of this document.
6741
6742 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6743 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6744 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6745 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6746 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6747 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6748 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6749 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6750
6751 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6752 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006753 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6754 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006755
6756 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6757 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6758 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6759 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6760 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6761
6762 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006763 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6764 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6765 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006766
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006767 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006768
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006769
6770timeout queue <timeout>
6771 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | no | yes | yes
6774 Arguments :
6775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6777 as explained at the top of this document.
6778
6779 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6780 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6781 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6782 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6783 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6784
6785 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6786 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6787 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6788 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6789
6790 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6791
6792
6793timeout server <timeout>
6794timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6795 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 yes | no | yes | yes
6798 Arguments :
6799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6801 as explained at the top of this document.
6802
6803 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6804 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6805 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6806 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6807 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6808 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6809 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6810
6811 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6812 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6813 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6814 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6815 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006816 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006817 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006818 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6819 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6820 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6821 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006822
6823 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6824 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6825 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6826 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6827 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6828 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6829
6830 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6831 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6832 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6833
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006834 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006835
6836
6837timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006838 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | yes
6841 Arguments :
6842 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6844 as explained at the top of this document.
6845
6846 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6847 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6848 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6849
6850 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6851 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6852 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6853 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006854 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006855
6856 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6857
6858
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006859timeout tunnel <timeout>
6860 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
6863 Arguments :
6864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6866 as explained at the top of this document.
6867
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006868 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006869 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6870 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6871 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6872 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6873 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6874 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6875 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6876 specified.
6877
6878 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6879 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6880 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6881 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6882 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6883
6884 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6885 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6886 forget about it.
6887
6888 Example :
6889 defaults http
6890 option http-server-close
6891 timeout connect 5s
6892 timeout client 30s
6893 timeout client 30s
6894 timeout server 30s
6895 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6896
6897 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6898
6899
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006900transparent (deprecated)
6901 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006903 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006904 Arguments : none
6905
6906 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6907 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6908 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6909 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6910 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6911 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6912 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6913 appropriate server.
6914
6915 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6916
6917 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6918 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6919
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006920 See also: "option transparent"
6921
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006922unique-id-format <string>
6923 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 yes | yes | yes | no
6926 Arguments :
6927 <string> is a log-format string.
6928
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006929 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6930 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6931 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6932 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006933
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006934 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6935 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6936 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6937 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6938 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6939 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6940 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6941 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006942
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006943 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6944 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006945
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006946 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006947
6948 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6949
6950 will generate:
6951
6952 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6953
6954 See also: "unique-id-header"
6955
6956unique-id-header <name>
6957 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 yes | yes | yes | no
6960 Arguments :
6961 <name> is the name of the header.
6962
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006963 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6964 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006965
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006966 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006967
6968 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6969 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6970
6971 will generate:
6972
6973 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6974
6975 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006976
6977use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6978use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006979 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6981 no | yes | yes | no
6982 Arguments :
6983 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006985 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006986
6987 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6988 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6989 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006990 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6991 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6992 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6993 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006994
6995 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6996 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6997 assign the backend.
6998
6999 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7000 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7001 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7002 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7003 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7004 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7005
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007006 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007007 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007008 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7009 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7010 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7011
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007012 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007013
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007014
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007015use-server <server> if <condition>
7016use-server <server> unless <condition>
7017 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | no | yes | yes
7020 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007021 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007022
7023 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7024
7025 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7026 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7027 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7028
7029 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7030 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7031 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7032 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7033 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7034 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7035 matches will assign the server.
7036
7037 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7038 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7039 with the next rules until one matches.
7040
7041 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7042 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7043 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7044 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7045
7046 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7047 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7048 stripped.
7049
7050 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7051 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7052 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7053 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7054
7055 Example :
7056 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7057 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7058 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7059 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7060 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7061 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7062 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7063 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7064 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7065
7066 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007068
70695. Bind and Server options
7070--------------------------
7071
7072The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7073depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7074settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7075written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7076described in this section.
7077
7078
70795.1. Bind options
7080-----------------
7081
7082The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7083as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7084no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7085parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7086while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7087provided immediately after the setting name.
7088
7089The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7090
7091accept-proxy
7092 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7093 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7094 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7095 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7096 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7097 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7098 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7099 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7100 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
7101 usable.
7102
7103backlog <backlog>
7104 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7105 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7106
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007107ecdhe <named curve>
7108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007109 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7110 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007111
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007112ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7114 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7115 client's certificate.
7116
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007117ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7119 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7120 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7121 error is ignored.
7122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007123ciphers <ciphers>
7124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7125 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7126 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7127 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7128 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7129
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007130crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7132 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7133 to verify client's certificate.
7134
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007135crt <cert>
7136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7137 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7138 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007139 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7140 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7141 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7142 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7143 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7144 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7145 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7146 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007147 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007148 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7149 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7150 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7151 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7152 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007153
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007154crt-ignore-err <errors>
7155 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7156 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7157 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7158 error is ignored.
7159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007160defer-accept
7161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7162 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7163 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7164 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7165 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7166 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7167 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7168 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7169 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7170 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7171 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7172
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007173force-sslv3
7174 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7175 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7176 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7177
7178force-tlsv10
7179 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7180 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7181
7182force-tlsv11
7183 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7184 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7185
7186force-tlsv12
7187 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7188 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7189
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007190gid <gid>
7191 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7192 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7193 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7194 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7195 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7196
7197group <group>
7198 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7199 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7200 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7201 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7202 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7203
7204id <id>
7205 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7206 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7207 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7208 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7209
7210interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007211 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7212 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7213 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7214 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7215 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7216 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7217 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007218
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007219level <level>
7220 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7221 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7222 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7223 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7224 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7225 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7226 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7227 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7228 counters).
7229 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7230 all counters).
7231
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007232maxconn <maxconn>
7233 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7234 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7235 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7236 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7237 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7238 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7239 eat all memory.
7240
7241mode <mode>
7242 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7243 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7244 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7245 UNIX sockets.
7246
7247mss <maxseg>
7248 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7249 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7250 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7251 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7252 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7253 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7254 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7255 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7256 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7257 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7258 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7259
7260name <name>
7261 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7262 page.
7263
7264nice <nice>
7265 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7266 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7267 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7268 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7269 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7270 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7271 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7272 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7273 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7274 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7275 one for an RDP socket.
7276
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007277no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7279 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7280 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007281 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7282 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007283
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007284no-tls-tickets
7285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7286 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7287 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7288 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7289
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007290no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007292 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7293 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7294 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7295 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007296
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007297no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007299 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7300 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7301 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7302 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007303
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007304no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007306 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7307 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7308 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7309 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007310
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007311npn <protocols>
7312 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7313 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7314 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7315 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7316 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007318ssl
7319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7320 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7321 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7322 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7323 to deciphered contents.
7324
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007325strict-sni
7326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7327 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7328 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7329 See the "crt" option for more information.
7330
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007331tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007332 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007333 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7334 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7335 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7336 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7337 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7338 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7339 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7340 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007342transparent
7343 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7344 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7345 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7346 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7347 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7348 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7349 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7350 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7351 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7352 so check for support with your vendor.
7353
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007354v4v6
7355 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7356 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7357 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7358 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7359 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7360
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007361v6only
7362 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7363 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7364 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007365 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7366 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007368uid <uid>
7369 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7370 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7371 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7372 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7373 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7374
7375user <user>
7376 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7377 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7378 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7379 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7380 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7381
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007382verify [none|optional|required]
7383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7384 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7385 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7386 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7387 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007388 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7389 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7390 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7391 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020073935.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007394------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007396The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7397which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7398arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7399settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7400after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7401Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7402address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007404 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007405 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007407The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007408
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007409addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007410 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7411 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7412 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7413 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7414 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007416 Supported in default-server: No
7417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007418backup
7419 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7420 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7421 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7422 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7423 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7424 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007426 Supported in default-server: No
7427
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007428ca-file <cafile>
7429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7430 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7431 server's certificate.
7432
7433 Supported in default-server: No
7434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007435check
7436 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007437 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7438 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7439 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7440 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7441 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7442 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7443 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007444 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7445 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7446 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7447 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007449 Supported in default-server: No
7450
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007451check-send-proxy
7452 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7453 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7454 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7455 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7456 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7457 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7458 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7459
7460 Supported in default-server: No
7461
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007462check-ssl
7463 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7464 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7465 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7466 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7467 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7468 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7469 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7470 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7471 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7472
7473 Supported in default-server: No
7474
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007475ciphers <ciphers>
7476 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7477 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7478 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7479 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7480 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7481 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7482 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7483 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7484
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007485 Supported in default-server: No
7486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007487cookie <value>
7488 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7489 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7490 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7491 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7492 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7493 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7494 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007496 Supported in default-server: No
7497
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007498crl-file <crlfile>
7499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7500 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7501 to verify server's certificate.
7502
7503 Supported in default-server: No
7504
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007505crt <cert>
7506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7507 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7508 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7509 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7510 certificate request.
7511
7512 Supported in default-server: No
7513
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007514disabled
7515 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7516 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7517 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7518 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7519 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7520
7521 Supported in default-server: No
7522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007523error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007524 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7525 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7526 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007528 Supported in default-server: Yes
7529
7530 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007532fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007533 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7534 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7535 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007537 Supported in default-server: Yes
7538
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007539force-sslv3
7540 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7541 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7542 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7543
7544 Supported in default-server: No
7545
7546force-tlsv10
7547 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7548 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7549
7550 Supported in default-server: No
7551
7552force-tlsv11
7553 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7554 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7555
7556 Supported in default-server: No
7557
7558force-tlsv12
7559 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7560 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7561
7562 Supported in default-server: No
7563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007564id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007565 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7566 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7567 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007569 Supported in default-server: No
7570
7571inter <delay>
7572fastinter <delay>
7573downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007574 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7575 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7576 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7577 between checks depending on the server state :
7578
7579 Server state | Interval used
7580 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7581 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7582 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7583 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7584 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7585 or yet unchecked. |
7586 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7587 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7588 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007590 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7591 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7592 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7593 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7594 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7595 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7596 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7597 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7598 servers.
7599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007600 Supported in default-server: Yes
7601
7602maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007603 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7604 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7605 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7606 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7607 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7608 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7609 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7610 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007612 Supported in default-server: Yes
7613
7614maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007615 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7616 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7617 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7618 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7619 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7620 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7621 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007623 Supported in default-server: Yes
7624
7625minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007626 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7627 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7628 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7629 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7630 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7631 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007632 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007633 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007635 Supported in default-server: Yes
7636
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007637no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007638 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7639 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007640 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007641
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007642 Supported in default-server: No
7643
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007644no-tls-tickets
7645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7646 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7647 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7648 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7649
7650 Supported in default-server: No
7651
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007652no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007653 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007654 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7655 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007656 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7657 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007658
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007659 Supported in default-server: No
7660
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007661no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007662 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007663 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7664 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007665 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7666 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007667
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007668 Supported in default-server: No
7669
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007670no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007671 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007672 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7673 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007674 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7675 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007676
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007677 Supported in default-server: No
7678
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007679non-stick
7680 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7681 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7682 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7683
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007684 Supported in default-server: No
7685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007686observe <mode>
7687 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7688 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7689 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7690 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7691 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7692 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007693 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007695 Supported in default-server: No
7696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007697 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007699on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007700 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7701 Currently, four modes are available:
7702 - fastinter: force fastinter
7703 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7704 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7705 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7706 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007708 Supported in default-server: Yes
7709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007710 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7711
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007712on-marked-down <action>
7713 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7714 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007715 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7716 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7717 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7718 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7719 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7720 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7721 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7722 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007723
7724 Actions are disabled by default
7725
7726 Supported in default-server: Yes
7727
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007728on-marked-up <action>
7729 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7730 Currently one action is available:
7731 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7732 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7733 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7734 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7735 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7736 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7737 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7738 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7739
7740 Actions are disabled by default
7741
7742 Supported in default-server: Yes
7743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007744port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007745 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7746 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7747 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7748 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7749 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7750 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007752 Supported in default-server: Yes
7753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007754redir <prefix>
7755 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7756 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7757 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7758 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7759 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7760 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7761 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7762 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007763 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007764 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7765 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7766 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7767 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7768 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7769
7770 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007772 Supported in default-server: No
7773
7774rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007775 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7776 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7777 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007779 Supported in default-server: Yes
7780
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007781send-proxy
7782 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7783 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7784 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7785 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7786 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7787 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7788 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7789 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7790 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007791 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7792 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7793 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7794 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7795 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007796
7797 Supported in default-server: No
7798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007799slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007800 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7801 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7802 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7803 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7804 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7805 parameters :
7806
7807 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7808 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7809
7810 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7811 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7812 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7813 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7814
7815 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7816 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7817 seen as failed.
7818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007819 Supported in default-server: Yes
7820
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007821source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007822source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007823source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007824 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7825 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7826 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7827 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7828
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007829 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7830 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7831 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7832 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7833 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7834 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7835 server.
7836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007837 Supported in default-server: No
7838
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007839ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007840 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7841 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7842 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7843 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7844 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7845 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7846 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7847 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7848
7849 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007851track [<proxy>/]<server>
7852 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7853 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7854 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7855 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7856 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007858 Supported in default-server: No
7859
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007860verify [none|required]
7861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7862 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7863 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7864 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7865 is aborted.
7866
7867 Supported in default-server: No
7868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007869weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007870 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7871 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7872 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007873 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7874 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7875 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7876 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7877 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7878 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007880 Supported in default-server: Yes
7881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007882
78836. HTTP header manipulation
7884---------------------------
7885
7886In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7887response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7888request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7889which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7890against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7891to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7892passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7893headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7894never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7895
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007896There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7897(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7898rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7899messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7900in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007901happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007902add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7903normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007905This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7906in section 4.2 :
7907
7908 - reqadd <string>
7909 - reqallow <search>
7910 - reqiallow <search>
7911 - reqdel <search>
7912 - reqidel <search>
7913 - reqdeny <search>
7914 - reqideny <search>
7915 - reqpass <search>
7916 - reqipass <search>
7917 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7918 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7919 - reqtarpit <search>
7920 - reqitarpit <search>
7921 - rspadd <string>
7922 - rspdel <search>
7923 - rspidel <search>
7924 - rspdeny <search>
7925 - rspideny <search>
7926 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7927 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7928
7929With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7930is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7931parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7932prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7933Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7934
7935 \t for a tab
7936 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7937 \n for a new line (LF)
7938 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7939 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7940 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7941 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7942 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7943
7944The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7945portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7946above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7947regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
79489 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7949is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7950
7951The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7952after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7953
7954Notes related to these keywords :
7955---------------------------------
7956 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7957 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7958 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7959
7960 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7961 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7962 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7963
7964 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7965 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7966 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7967 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7968 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7969
7970 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7971 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7972 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7973 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7974 useless headers before adding new ones.
7975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007976 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007977 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7978
7979 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7980 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7981 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7982
7983 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7984 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007985 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007986
7987
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079887. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7989------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007990
7991The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7992content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7993from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7994simple :
7995
7996 - define test criteria with sets of values
7997 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7998
7999The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
8000
8001In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8002
8003 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
8004
8005This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8006Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8007and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8008an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8009of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8010
8011ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8012'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8013which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8014
8015There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8016performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8017
8018The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8019
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008020 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8021 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008022 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8023
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008024The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
8025specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
8026possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02008027multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
8028be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
8029needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
8030space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
8031match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
8032lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
8033duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008034to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02008035instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008036
8037 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8038
8039In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8040the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8041case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8042too.
8043
8044Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
8045a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
8046ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
8047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008048Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008049
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008050 - integers or integer ranges
8051 - strings
8052 - regular expressions
8053 - IP addresses and networks
8054
8055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080567.1. Matching integers
8057----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008058
8059Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
8060that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
8061expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
8062may be omitted.
8063
8064For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8065unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8066representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8067
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008068As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8069two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8070instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8071ranges and operators.
8072
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008073For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008074operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8075Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8076of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008078Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008079
8080 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8081 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8082 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8083 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8084 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008086For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008087
8088 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8089
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008090This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8091
8092 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8093
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080957.2. Matching strings
8096---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008097
8098String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8099exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8100characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8101string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8102to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008103before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008104
8105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081067.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8107-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008108
8109Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8110they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8111possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8112passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8113the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008114the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8115match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008116
8117
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020081187.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008119----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008120
8121IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8122netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8123within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008124host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008125difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8126at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8127does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8128parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008129
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008130IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8131Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8132trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8133IPv6 patterns.
8134
8135HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8136following situations :
8137 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8138 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8139 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8140 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8141 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8142 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8143 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8144 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8145 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8146 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8147
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081497.5. Available matching criteria
8150--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081527.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8153------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008154
8155A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8156analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008157addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008158
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008159always_false
8160 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8161 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8162
8163always_true
8164 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8165 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8166
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008167avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008168avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008169 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8170 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8171 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8172 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8173 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8174 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8175 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8176 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8177 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8178 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8179 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008180
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008181be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008182be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008183 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8184 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8185 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8186 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8187 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008188
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008189be_id <integer>
8190 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8191 backend it was called.
8192
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008193be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008194be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008195 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8196 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8197 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8198 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8199 sucking of an online dictionary).
8200
8201 Example :
8202 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8203 backend dynamic
8204 mode http
8205 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8206 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008207
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008208srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8209 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8210 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8211 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8212 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8213 latent requests from overloading servers).
8214
8215 Example :
8216 # Redirect to a separate back
8217 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8218 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8219 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8220
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008221connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008222connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008223 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008224 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008225 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008227 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8228 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008229
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008230 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008231 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8232 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8233 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8234 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8235 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008236 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008237
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008238 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8239 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8240 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8241 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008242
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008243dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008244 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8245 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008246
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008247dst_conn <integer>
8248 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8249 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8250 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8251 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8252 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8253 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8254
8255dst_port <integer>
8256 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8257 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8258
8259fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008260fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008261 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8262 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8263 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8264 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8265 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8266 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8267 criteria.
8268
8269fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008270 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008271 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008272
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008273fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008274fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008275 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8276 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8277 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8278 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8279 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8280 the rate to go down below the limit.
8281
8282 Example :
8283 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8284 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8285 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8286 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8287 frontend mail
8288 bind :25
8289 mode tcp
8290 maxconn 100
8291 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8292 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8293 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8294 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008296nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008297nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008298 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8299 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8300 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8301 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8302 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008304queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008305queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008306 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8307 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8308 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8309 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8310 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8311 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8312 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8313
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008314sc1_bytes_in_rate <integer>
8315sc2_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008316 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8317 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8318 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8319
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008320sc1_bytes_out_rate <integer>
8321sc2_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008322 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8323 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8324 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8325
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008326sc1_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8327sc2_clr_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008328 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8329 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008330 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
8331 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8332 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008333
8334 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8335 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8336 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8337 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008338 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008339 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8340 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8341
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008342sc1_conn_cnt <integer>
8343sc2_conn_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008344 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8345 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8346
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008347sc1_conn_cur <integer>
8348sc2_conn_cur <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008349 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8350 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8351 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8352
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008353sc1_conn_rate <integer>
8354sc2_conn_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008355 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8356 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8357 See also src_conn_rate.
8358
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008359sc1_get_gpc0 <integer>
8360sc2_get_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008361 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8362 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8363
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008364sc1_http_err_cnt <integer>
8365sc2_http_err_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008366 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8367 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8368 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8369
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008370sc1_http_err_rate <integer>
8371sc2_http_err_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008372 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8373 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8374 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8375 src_http_err_rate.
8376
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008377sc1_http_req_cnt <integer>
8378sc2_http_req_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008379 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8380 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8381 src_http_req_cnt.
8382
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008383sc1_http_req_rate <integer>
8384sc2_http_req_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008385 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8386 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8387 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8388 src_http_req_rate.
8389
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008390sc1_inc_gpc0 <integer>
8391sc2_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008392 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008393 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
8394 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8395 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
8396 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008397
8398 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008399 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008400 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8401
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008402sc1_kbytes_in <integer>
8403sc2_kbytes_in <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008404 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8405 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8406 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8407 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8408
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008409sc1_kbytes_out <integer>
8410sc2_kbytes_out <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008411 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8412 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8413 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8414 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8415
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008416sc1_sess_cnt <integer>
8417sc2_sess_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008418 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8419 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8420 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8421 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008422 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008423 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8424
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008425sc1_sess_rate <integer>
8426sc2_sess_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008427 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8428 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8429 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8430 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8431 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008432 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008433
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008434sc1_trackers <integer>
8435sc2_trackers <integer>
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008436 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8437 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8438 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8439 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8440 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8441 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8442
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008443so_id <integer>
8444 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8445
8446src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008447 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8448 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8449 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008450
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008451src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008452src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008453 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8454 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8455 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008456 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008457
8458src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008459src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008460 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8461 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8462 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008463 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008464
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008465src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8466src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8467 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8468 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8469 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008470 entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in
8471 an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008472
8473 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8474 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8475 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8476 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008477 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008478 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8479 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8480
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008481src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008482src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008483 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8484 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8485 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008486 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008487
8488src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008489src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008490 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8491 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8492 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008493 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008494
8495src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008496src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008497 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8498 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8499 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008500 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008501
8502src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008503src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008504 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8505 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8506 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008507 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008508
8509src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008510src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008511 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8512 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8513 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008514 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008515
8516src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008517src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008518 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8519 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8520 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8521 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008522 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008523
8524src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008525src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008526 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8527 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8528 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008529 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008530
8531src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008532src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008533 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8534 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8535 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8536 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008537 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008538
8539src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008540src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008541 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8542 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008543 stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not found, an entry
8544 is created and 1 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in an
8545 expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008546
8547 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008548 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008549 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008550
8551src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008552src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008553 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8554 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8555 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8556 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008557 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008558
8559src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008560src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008561 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8562 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8563 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8564 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008565 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008566
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008567src_port <integer>
8568 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008569
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008570src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008571src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008572 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8573 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8574 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8575 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008576 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008577
8578src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008579src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008580 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8581 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8582 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8583 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008584 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008585
8586src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008587src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008588 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008589 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8590 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008591 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8592 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8593 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008594 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008595
8596 Example :
8597 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8598 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8599 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8600 listen ssh
8601 bind :22
8602 mode tcp
8603 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008604 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008605 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8606 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8607
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008608srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008609 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8610 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8611 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8612 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8613
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008614srv_id <integer>
8615 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8616
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008617srv_is_up(<server>)
8618srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8619 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8620 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8621 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8622 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8623 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8624 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8625 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8626 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8627
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008628table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008629table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008630 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8632
8633table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008634table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008635 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8636 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8637 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008639
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020086407.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8641---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008642
8643A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8644during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008645through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8646keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008647
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008648rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8649 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8650 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8651 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008652 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8653 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8654 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008655
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008656req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008657 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008658 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8659 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8660 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8661 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8662 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8663 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8664
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008665req_proto_http
8666 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8667 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008668 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008669 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8670 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8671
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008672req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008673req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008674 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8675 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8676 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8677 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8678 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8679 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8680 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8681 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8682
8683req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008684req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008685 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8686 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8687 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8688 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8689 cookies.
8690
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008691req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8692 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8693 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8694 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008695 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8696 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8697 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008698
8699req_ssl_sni <string>
8700 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8701 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8702 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8703 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8704 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8705 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8706 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008707 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8708 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008709 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008710 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008711
8712 Examples :
8713 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8714 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8715 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8716 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8717 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8718
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008719req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8720 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8721 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8722 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8723 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8724 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8725 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008726 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8727 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008728 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008729 option.
8730
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008731ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8732 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8733 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8734 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8735 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8736 during this verification process.
8737
8738ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8739 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8740 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8741 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8742 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8743
8744ssl_c_err <integer>
8745 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8746 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8747 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8748 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8749
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008750ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8751ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8752 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8753 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8754 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8755 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8756 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8757 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8758 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8759 DN matches the specified string.
8760
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008761ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8762 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8763 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8764 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8765
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008766ssl_c_notafter <string>
8767 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8768 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8769 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8770
8771ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8772 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8773 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8774 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8775
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008776ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8777ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8778 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8779 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8780 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8781 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8782 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8783 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8784 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8785 DN matches the specified string.
8786
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008787ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8788 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8789 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8790 the value written in hexa.
8791
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008792ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8793 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8794 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8795 by the client matches the string.
8796
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008797ssl_c_used
8798 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8799 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8800
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008801ssl_c_verify <integer>
8802 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8803 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8804 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8805
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008806ssl_c_version <integer>
8807 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8808 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8809 the value.
8810
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008811ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8812ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8813 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8814 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8815 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8816 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8817 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8818 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8819 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8820 DN matches the specified string.
8821
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008822ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8823 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8824 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8825 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8826
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008827ssl_f_notafter <string>
8828 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8829 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8830 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8831
8832ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8833 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8834 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8835 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8836
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008837ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8838ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8839 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8840 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8841 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8842 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8843 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8844 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8845 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8846 DN matches the specified string.
8847
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008848ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8849 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8850 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8851 the value written in hexa.
8852
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008853ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8854 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8855 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8856 by the frontend matches the string.
8857
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008858ssl_f_version <integer>
8859 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8860 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8861 the value.
8862
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008863ssl_fc
8864 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8865 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8866 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8867
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008868ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8869 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8870 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8871
8872ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8873 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8874 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8875
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008876ssl_fc_has_crt
8877 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8878 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008879 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8880 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8881 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8882 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008883
8884ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008885 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008886 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8887 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8888 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8889 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008890
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008891ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008892 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8893 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8894 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8895 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008896 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8897 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8898 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008899
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008900ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8901 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8902 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8903
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008904ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008905 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8906 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8907 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8908 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008909 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8910 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008911 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8912 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8913 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008914
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008915ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008916 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8917 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8918 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8919 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008920 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8921 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8922 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8923 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008924
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008925ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008926 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8927 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8928 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8929 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008930 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8931 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8932 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8933 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008934
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008935ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8936 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8937 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8938
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008939wait_end
8940 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8941 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8942 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8943 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8944 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8945 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8946 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8947 inspection.
8948
8949 Examples :
8950 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8951 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8952 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8953
8954 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8955 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8956 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8957 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8958 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8959 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8960 tcp-request content reject
8961
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089637.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8964--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008965
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008966A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008967application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8968read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8969than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8970
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008971base <string>
8972 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8973 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8974 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8975 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8976 See also "path" and "uri".
8977
8978base_beg <string>
8979 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8980 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8981 "path_beg".
8982
8983base_dir <string>
8984 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8985 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8986 "path_dir" instead.
8987
8988base_dom <string>
8989 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8990 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8991 instead.
8992
8993base_end <string>
8994 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8995 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8996
8997base_len <integer>
8998 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8999 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9000
9001base_reg <regex>
9002 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
9003 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9004 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
9005 and all "base_" criteria.
9006
9007base_sub <string>
9008 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
9009 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
9010 also "base_dir".
9011
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009012cook(<name>) <string>
9013 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
9014 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
9015 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
9016 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
9017 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
9018 sent by the server.
9019
9020 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
9021 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
9022 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
9023
9024 cook(profile) silver gold
9025
9026cook_beg(<name>) <string>
9027 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
9028 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9029 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9030
9031cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
9032 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
9033 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
9034 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
9035 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
9036 server.
9037
9038cook_dir(<name>) <string>
9039 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
9040 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9041 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
9042 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
9043 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9044
9045cook_dom(<name>) <string>
9046 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
9047 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
9048 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9049 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9050
9051cook_end(<name>) <string>
9052 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
9053 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9054 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9055
9056cook_len(<name>) <integer>
9057 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
9058 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9059 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
9060 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
9061 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9062
9063cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
9064 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
9065 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
9066 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
9067 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9068 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9069
9070cook_sub(<name>) <string>
9071 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
9072 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9073 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9074
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009075cook_val(<name>) <integer>
9076 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
9077 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
9078 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
9079 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9080 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9081
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009082hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009083hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009084 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
9085 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
9086 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
9087 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009088 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
9089 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
9090 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9091 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
9092 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009093
9094 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009095 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009096 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
9097
9098 hdr(Connection) -i close
9099
9100hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009101hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009102 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
9103 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
9104 response headers sent by the server.
9105
9106hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009107hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009108 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
9109 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
9110 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9111 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9112 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9113 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9114 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9115
9116hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009117hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009118 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9119 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9120 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9121 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9122 headers sent by the server.
9123
9124hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009125hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009126 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9127 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9128 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9129 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9130 server.
9131
9132hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009133hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009134 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9135 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9136 response headers sent by the server.
9137
9138hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009139hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9140 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9141 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9142 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009143 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9144
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009145hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009146hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009147 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9148 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9149 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9150 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9151
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009152hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009153hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009154 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009155 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9156 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9157 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9158 response headers sent by the server.
9159
9160hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009161hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009162 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9163 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9164 response headers sent by the server.
9165
9166hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009167hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009168 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9169 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9170 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9171 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9172
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009173http_auth(<userlist>)
9174http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009175 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9176 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9177 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9178 of specified groups.
9179
9180 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9181
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009182http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009183 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9184 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9185 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9186 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9187
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009188method <string>
9189 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9190 already check for most common methods.
9191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009192path <string>
9193 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9194 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9195 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9196
9197path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009198 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9199 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009201path_dir <string>
9202 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9203 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9204 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9205 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9206
9207path_dom <string>
9208 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9209 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9210 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9211
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009212path_end <string>
9213 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9214 control file name extension.
9215
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009216path_len <integer>
9217 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9218 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009220path_reg <regex>
9221 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9222 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9223 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009225path_sub <string>
9226 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9227 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9228 "path_dir".
9229
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009230payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9231 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9232 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9233 strings.
9234
9235payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9236 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9237 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9238 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9239 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9240 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009242req_ver <string>
9243 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9244 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9245
9246status <integer>
9247 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9248 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9249 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9250
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009251url <string>
9252 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009253 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009254
9255url_beg <string>
9256 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009257 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9258 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009260url_dir <string>
9261 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9262 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9263 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9264 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9265
9266url_dom <string>
9267 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9268 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9269 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9270
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009271url_end <string>
9272 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9273 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009274
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009275url_ip <address>
9276 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9277 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9278 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009279
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009280url_len <integer>
9281 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9282 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9283
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009284url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009285 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9286 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009287 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009288 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009290url_reg <regex>
9291 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9292 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009293 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009295url_sub <string>
9296 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9297 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009298
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009299urlp(<name>) <string>
9300 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9301 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9302
9303 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9304 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9305
9306urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9307 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9308 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9309 protocol scheme.
9310
9311urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9312 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9313 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9314 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9315 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9316
9317urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9318 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9319 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9320 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9321 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9322
9323urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9324 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9325
9326urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009327 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9328 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009329
9330urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9331 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9332 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9333
9334urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9335 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9336 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9337 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9338 "urlp_" criteria.
9339
9340urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9341 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9342 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9343 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9344
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009345urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9346 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9347 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9348 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9349 negative data.
9350
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093527.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9353---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009355Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9356every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009357order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009359ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9360---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009361FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009362HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009363HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9364HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009365HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9366HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9367HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9368HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9369LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009370METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9371METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9372METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9373METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9374METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9375METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009376RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009377REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009378TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009379WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9380---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009381
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093837.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9384----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009386Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9387combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009389 - AND (implicit)
9390 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9391 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009393A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009395 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9398indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009400For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9401"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9402requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9403is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009405 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9406 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9407 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9408 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9411and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009413 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9414 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9415 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9416 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009418 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9419 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9420 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9421 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009422
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009423It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9424expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9425be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009426the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009427
9428 The following rule :
9429
9430 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9431 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9432
9433 Can also be written that way :
9434
9435 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9436
9437It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9438to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9439simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9440sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9441good use is the following :
9442
9443 With named ACLs :
9444
9445 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9446 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9447 monitor fail if site_dead
9448
9449 With anonymous ACLs :
9450
9451 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009453See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009454
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009455
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010094567.8. Pattern extraction
9457-----------------------
9458
9459The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9460response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9461for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9462
9463All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9464"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9465begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9466arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9467much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9468equivalent used in ACLs.
9469
9470The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9471
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009472 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9473 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9474 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9475 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9476 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9477 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9478 requested objects by host/path.
9479
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009480 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9481 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9482 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9483 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9484 is an unsigned integer.
9485
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009486 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9487 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9488 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9489 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9490
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009491 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009492 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9493 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9494 according to RFC 4291.
9495
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009496 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9497 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9498 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009499 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9500 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9501 according to RFC 4291.
9502
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009503 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9504 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9505 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9506 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9507 type integer and only works with such tables.
9508
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009509 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9510 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9511 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9512 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9513 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9514 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9515 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009516 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009517
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009518 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9519 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9520 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9521 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9522 wiser to use "url" instead.
9523
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009524 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009525 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9526 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9527 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9528 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009529
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009530 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009531 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9532 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9533 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9534 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9535 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9536 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9537 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9538 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009539
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009540 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9541 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9542 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9543 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9544
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009545 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9546 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9547
9548 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9549 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9550 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9551
9552 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9553 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9554
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009555 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9556 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9557 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9558 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009559 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9560 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009561 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9562 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9563 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9564 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9565 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9566
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009567 ssl_c_key_alg
9568 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9569 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9570 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9571
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009572 ssl_c_notafter
9573 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9574 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9575 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9576
9577 ssl_c_notbefore
9578 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9579 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9580 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9581
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009582 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9583 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9584 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9585 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009586 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9587 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009588 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9589 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9590 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9591 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9592 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9593
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009594 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9595 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9596 layer.
9597
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009598 ssl_c_sig_alg
9599 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9600 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9601 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9602
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009603 ssl_c_used
9604 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9605 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9606
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009607 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9608 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9609 error is encountered.
9610
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009611 ssl_c_version
9612 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9613 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9614 layer.
9615
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009616 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9617 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9618 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9619 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009620 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9621 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009622 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9623 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9624 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9625 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9626 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9627
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009628 ssl_f_key_alg
9629 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9630 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9631 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9632
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009633 ssl_f_notafter
9634 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9635 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9636 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9637
9638 ssl_f_notbefore
9639 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9640 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9641 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9642
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009643 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9644 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9645 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9646 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009647 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9648 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009649 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9650 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9651 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9652 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9653 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9654
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009655 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9656 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9657 layer.
9658
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009659 ssl_f_sig_alg
9660 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9661 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9662 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9663
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009664 ssl_f_version
9665 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9666 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9667 layer.
9668
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009669 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9670 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9671 otherwise zero.
9672
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009673 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9674 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9675 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9676
9677 ssl_fc_cipher
9678 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9679 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9680
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009681 ssl_fc_has_crt
9682 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9683 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009684 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9685 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9686 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9687 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9688 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009689
9690 ssl_fc_has_sni
9691 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009692 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9693 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009694 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009695 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009696
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009697 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009698 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9699 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9700 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9701 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009702 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009703
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009704 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009705 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9706 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009707
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009708 ssl_fc_session_id
9709 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9710 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9711 stick on a given client.
9712
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009713 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009714 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9715 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9716 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9717 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9718 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009719
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009720 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9721 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9722 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9723
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009724 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9725 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9726 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9727 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9728
9729 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9730 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9731 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9732 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9733 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9734 table for a given source address.
9735
9736 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9737 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9738
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009739 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009740 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009741 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9742 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9743 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9744 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9745 where cookies cannot be used.
9746
9747 Example :
9748 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9749 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9750 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9751 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009752
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009753 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009754 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9755 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9756 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9757 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009759 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9760 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9761 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9762 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9763 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9764 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9765 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009766
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009767 Example :
9768 listen tse-farm
9769 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9770 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9771 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9772 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9773 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9774 persist rdp-cookie
9775 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9776 # This is only useful makes sense if
9777 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9778 stick-table type string size 204800
9779 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9780 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9781 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009782
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009783 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9784 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009785
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009786 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009787 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009788 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9789 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9790 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9791 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9792 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9793 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009794
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009795 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009796
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009797 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009798 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9799 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9800 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9801
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009802 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9803 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9804 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9805 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9806 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009807
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009808 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009809
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009810
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009811The currently available list of transformations include :
9812
9813 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9814 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9815 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9816
9817 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9818 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9819 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9820
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009821 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009822 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9823 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9824 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9825 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9826
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098288. Logging
9829----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009830
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009831One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9832provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9833very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9834provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9835state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009836to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009837headers.
9838
9839In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9840about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9841send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9842
9843 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9844 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9845 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9846 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9847 at the termination.
9848
9849The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9850allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9851as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9852while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9853real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9854delay.
9855
9856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098578.1. Log levels
9858---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009859
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009860TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009861source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009862HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9863in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9864track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9865syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9866about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009867
9868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098698.2. Log formats
9870----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009871
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009872HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009873and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9874slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9875options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009876
9877 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9878 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9879 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9880 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9881 extents.
9882
9883 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9884 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9885 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9886 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9887 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9888
9889 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9890 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9891 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9892 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9893 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9894
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009895 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9896 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9897 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9898 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9899
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009900 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009902Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9903specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9904field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9905servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9906always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9907identifier.
9908
9909Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9910 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9911 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9912 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9913 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9914
9915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099168.2.1. Default log format
9917-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009918
9919This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9920as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9921format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9922
9923 Example :
9924 listen www
9925 mode http
9926 log global
9927 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9928
9929 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9930 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9931 (www/HTTP)
9932
9933 Field Format Extract from the example above
9934 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9935 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9936 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9937 4 'to' to
9938 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9939 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9940
9941Detailed fields description :
9942 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9943 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9944 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9945 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9946 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9947 and processed the connection.
9948 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9949
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009950In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9951"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9952connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9953
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009954It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9955will eventually disappear.
9956
9957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099588.2.2. TCP log format
9959---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009960
9961The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9962is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9963information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9964counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9965emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9966environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9967the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9968sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009969specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9970not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9971fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9972marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009973
9974 Example :
9975 frontend fnt
9976 mode tcp
9977 option tcplog
9978 log global
9979 default_backend bck
9980
9981 backend bck
9982 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9983
9984 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9985 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9986 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9987
9988 Field Format Extract from the example above
9989 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9990 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9991 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9992 4 frontend_name fnt
9993 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9994 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9995 7 bytes_read* 212
9996 8 termination_state --
9997 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9998 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9999
10000Detailed fields description :
10001 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010002 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10003 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10004 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10005 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10006 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010007
10008 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010009 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10010 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10011 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010012
10013 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10014 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10015 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10016 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10017
10018 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10019 and processed the connection.
10020
10021 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10022 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10023 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10024 applications.
10025
10026 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10027 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10028 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10029 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10030 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10031
10032 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10033 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10034 See "Timers" below for more details.
10035
10036 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10037 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10038 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10039 "Timers" below for more details.
10040
10041 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10042 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10043 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10044 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10045 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10046 details.
10047
10048 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10049 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10050 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10051 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10052 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10053
10054 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10055 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10056 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10057 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10058 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10059 for more details.
10060
10061 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010062 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010063 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10064 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10065 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010066 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010067
10068 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10069 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10070 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10071 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10072 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10073 caused by a denial of service attack.
10074
10075 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10076 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10077 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10078 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10079 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10080 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10081 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10082 denial of service attack.
10083
10084 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10085 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10086 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10087 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10088 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10089 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10090 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10091 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10092 be processed than on other servers.
10093
10094 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10095 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10096 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10097 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10098 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10099 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10100 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10101 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10102 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10103 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10104 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10105 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10106 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10107
10108 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10109 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10110 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10111 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10112 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10113 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10114 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10115 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10116
10117 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10118 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10119 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10120 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10121 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10122 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10123 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10124 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10125 occurs.
10126
10127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101288.2.3. HTTP log format
10129----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010130
10131The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10132is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10133the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10134are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10135emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10136generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10137"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10138which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010139frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10140is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010141
10142Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10143slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10144with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10145
10146 Example :
10147 frontend http-in
10148 mode http
10149 option httplog
10150 log global
10151 default_backend bck
10152
10153 backend static
10154 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10155
10156 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10157 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10158 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010159 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010160
10161 Field Format Extract from the example above
10162 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10163 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10164 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10165 4 frontend_name http-in
10166 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10167 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10168 7 status_code 200
10169 8 bytes_read* 2750
10170 9 captured_request_cookie -
10171 10 captured_response_cookie -
10172 11 termination_state ----
10173 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10174 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10175 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10176 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10177 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010179
10180Detailed fields description :
10181 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010182 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10183 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10184 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10185 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10186 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010187
10188 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010189 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10190 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10191 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010192
10193 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10194 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10195 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10196 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10197 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10198
10199 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10200 and processed the connection.
10201
10202 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10203 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10204 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10205
10206 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10207 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10208 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10209 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10210 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10211 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10212
10213 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10214 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10215 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10216 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10217 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10218 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10219
10220 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10221 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10222 See "Timers" below for more details.
10223
10224 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10225 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10226 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10227 below for more details.
10228
10229 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10230 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10231 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10232 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10233 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10234 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10235 for more details.
10236
10237 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10238 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10239 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10240 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10241 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10242 details.
10243
10244 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10245 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10246 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10247
10248 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10249 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10250 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10251 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10252 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10253 overflowing.
10254
10255 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10256 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10257 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10258 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10259 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10260 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10261 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10262 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10263
10264 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10265 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10266 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10267 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10268 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10269 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10270 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10271 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10272
10273 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10274 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10275 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10276 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10277 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10278 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10279 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10280
10281 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010282 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010283 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10284 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10285 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010286 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010287 system.
10288
10289 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10290 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10291 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10292 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10293 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10294 caused by a denial of service attack.
10295
10296 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10297 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10298 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10299 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10300 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10301 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10302 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10303 denial of service attack.
10304
10305 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10306 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10307 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10308 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10309 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10310 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10311 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10312 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10313 processed than on other servers.
10314
10315 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10316 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10317 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10318 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10319 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10320 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10321 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10322 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10323 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10324 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10325 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10326 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10327 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10328
10329 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10330 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10331 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10332 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10333 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10334 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10335 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10336 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10337
10338 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10339 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10340 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10341 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10342 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10343 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10344 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10345 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10346 occurs.
10347
10348 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10349 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10350 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10351 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10352 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10353 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10354 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10355 cookies" below for more details.
10356
10357 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10358 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10359 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10360 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10361 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10362 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10363 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10364 and cookies" below for more details.
10365
10366 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10367 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10368 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10369 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10370 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10371 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10372 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10373 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10374
10375
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200103768.2.4. Custom log format
10377------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010378
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010379The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010380mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010381
10382HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10383Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10384separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10385prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10386
10387Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10388variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10389string formats ("Q").
10390
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010391If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10392as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10393less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10394the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10395
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010396Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10397HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10398
10399Flags are :
10400 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010401 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010402
10403 Example:
10404
10405 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10406 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10407
10408At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10409
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010410 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10411 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010412
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010413the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010414
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010415 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010416 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010417 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010418
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010419and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10420
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010421 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010422 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10423
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010424Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10425
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010426 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010427 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010428 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10429 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10430 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010431 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10432 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10433 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010434 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010435 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010436 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010437 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010438 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010439 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010440 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10441 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010442 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010443 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10444 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010445 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010446 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10447 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010448 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10449 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10450 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010451 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010452 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10453 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010454 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010455 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10456 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10457 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010458 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010459 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10460 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10461 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10462 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010463 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010464 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010465 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010466 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010467 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010468 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010469 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10470 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10471 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010472 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010473 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10474 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010475 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010476 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010477 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010478 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010479
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010480 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010481
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010482
104838.2.5. Error log format
10484-----------------------
10485
10486When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10487protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10488By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10489"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10490will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10491logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10492
10493The format looks like this :
10494
10495 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10496 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10497 Connection error during SSL handshake
10498
10499 Field Format Extract from the example above
10500 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10501 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10502 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10503 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10504 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10505
10506These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10507failures.
10508
10509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105108.3. Advanced logging options
10511-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010512
10513Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10514just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10515options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10516for more information about their usage.
10517
10518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105198.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10520------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010521
10522It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10523haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10524commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10525monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10526ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10527
10528 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10529 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10530 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10531 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10532
10533 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10534 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10535 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10536 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10537 such as other load-balancers.
10538
10539 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10540 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10541 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10542
10543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105448.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10545----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010546
10547The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10548what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10549or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10550"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10551just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10552log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10553after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10554is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10555with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10556with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10557
10558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105598.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10560------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010561
10562Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10563for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10564"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10565retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10566raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10567a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10568file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10569you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10570"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10571
10572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105738.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10574--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010575
10576Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10577multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10578them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10579"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10580logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10581error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10582and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10583too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10584useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10585alternative.
10586
10587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105888.4. Timing events
10589------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010590
10591Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10592reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10593the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10594frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10595mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10596
10597 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10598 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10599 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10600 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10601 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10602
10603 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10604 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10605 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10606 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10607 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10608
10609 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10610 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10611 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10612 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10613 connection never established.
10614
10615 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10616 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10617 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10618 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10619 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10620 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10621 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10622 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10623 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10624 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10625 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10626
10627 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10628 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10629 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10630 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10631 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10632
10633 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10634
10635 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10636 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10637 negative.
10638
10639These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10640protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10641that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010642due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010643close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10644session has been aborted on timeout.
10645
10646Most common cases :
10647
10648 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10649 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10650 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10651 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10652 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10653 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10654 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10655 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10656 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010657 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10658 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10659 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010660
10661 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10662 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10663 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10664 of ms on remote networks.
10665
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010666 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10667 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10668 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010669
10670 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10671 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10672 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10673 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10674 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10675 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10676 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10677 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10678 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10679 to the server until another one is released.
10680
10681Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10682
10683 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10684 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10685 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10686
10687 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10688 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10689 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10690
10691 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10692 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10693 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10694 flags.
10695
10696 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10697 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10698 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10699 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10700 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10701 the client connection was maintained open.
10702
10703 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10704 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10705 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10706 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10707
10708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107098.5. Session state at disconnection
10710-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010711
10712TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10713"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
107142-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10715each of which has a special meaning :
10716
10717 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10718 session to terminate :
10719
10720 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10721
10722 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10723 server explicitly refused it.
10724
10725 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10726 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10727 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10728 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10729 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10730 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10731
10732 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10733 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10734 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10735 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10736 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10737
10738 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10739 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10740 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10741 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10742 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10743
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010744 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10745 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10746
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010747 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10748 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10749 backup connections when going up.
10750
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010751 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10752
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010753 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10754 send or receive data.
10755
10756 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10757 send or receive data.
10758
10759 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10760 with nothing left in the buffers.
10761
10762 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10763
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010764 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010765 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10766
10767 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10768 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10769 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10770 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10771 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10772
10773 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10774 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10775
10776 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10777 server (HTTP only).
10778
10779 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10780
10781 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10782 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10783 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10784
10785 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10786 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10787 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10788
10789 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10790
10791 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10792 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10793
10794 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10795 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10796 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10797
10798 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10799 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010800 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10801 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010802
10803 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10804 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10805 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10806 another server.
10807
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010808 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010809 server.
10810
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010811 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10812 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10813 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10814 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10815
10816 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10817 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10818 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10819 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10820
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010821 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10822 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10823 "use-server" rule).
10824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010825 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10826
10827 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10828 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10829
10830 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10831
10832 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10833 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10834 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10835
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010836 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10837 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10838 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10839 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10840 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10841
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010842 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10843
10844 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10845 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10846
10847 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10848
10849 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10850
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010851The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10852was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010853helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10854starvation, attacks, etc...
10855
10856The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10857alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10858easier finding and understanding.
10859
10860 Flags Reason
10861
10862 -- Normal termination.
10863
10864 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10865 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10866 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10867 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10868
10869 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10870 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10871 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10872 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10873 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10874 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010875
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010876 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10877 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010878 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010879
10880 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10881 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10882 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10883
10884 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10885 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10886 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10887 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10888 the server takes too long to respond.
10889
10890 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10891 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10892 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10893 long a time to respond.
10894
10895 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10896 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10897 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10898 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10899 and the client.
10900
10901 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10902 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10903 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10904 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10905 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10906 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10907
10908 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10909 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010910 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10911 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10912 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10913 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010915 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010916 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10917 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10918 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10919 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10920 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10921
10922 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10923 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10924 503 or 504 here.
10925
10926 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10927 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10928 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10929 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10930 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10931
10932 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10933 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010934 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010935 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10936 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10937
10938 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10939 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10940 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10941 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10942 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10943 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10944 between haproxy and the server.
10945
10946 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10947 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10948 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10949 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10950 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10951 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10952 solution is to fix the application.
10953
10954 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10955 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10956 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10957 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10958 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10959 external attacks.
10960
10961 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10962 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010963 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010964 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10965 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10966
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010967 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10968 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10969 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10970 the client.
10971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010972 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10973 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10974 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10975 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010976 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10977 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10978 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10979 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10980 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010981
10982 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10983 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10984 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10985 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10986
10987 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10988 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10989 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10990 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10991
10992 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10993 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10994 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10995 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10996
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010997The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10998persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10999important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11000re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11001
11002 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11003
11004 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11005 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11006 set on a GET request.
11007
11008 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11009 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011010 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011011 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11012
11013 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11014 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11015 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11016
11017 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11018 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11019 already got a cookie.
11020
11021 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11022 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11023 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11024 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11025 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11026
11027 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11028 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11029 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11030
11031 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11032 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11033 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11034
11035 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11036 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11037
11038 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11039 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11040 then advertised in the response.
11041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110438.6. Non-printable characters
11044-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011045
11046In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11047consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11048converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11049prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11050being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11051escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11052is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11053'}' when logging headers.
11054
11055Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11056issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11057containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11058
11059Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11060the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11061performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11062
11063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110648.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11065---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011066
11067Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11068achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011069section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011070cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11071the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11072the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011073locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011074not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11075user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11076a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11077wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11078
11079 Examples :
11080 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11081 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11082
11083 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11084 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11085
11086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11088---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011089
11090Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11091proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11092the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11093server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11094
11095Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11096response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011097section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011098
11099It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011100time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11101appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011102are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11103and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11104follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11105request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11106in the logs.
11107
11108 Example :
11109 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11110 listen proxy-out
11111 mode http
11112 option httplog
11113 option logasap
11114 log global
11115 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11116
11117 # log the name of the virtual server
11118 capture request header Host len 20
11119
11120 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11121 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11122
11123 # log the beginning of the referrer
11124 capture request header Referer len 20
11125
11126 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11127 capture response header Server len 20
11128
11129 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11130 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11131
11132 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11133 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11134
11135 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11136 capture response header Via len 20
11137
11138 # log the URL location during a redirection
11139 capture response header Location len 20
11140
11141 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11142 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11143 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11144 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11145 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11146
11147 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11148 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11149 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11150 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011151 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011152
11153 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11154 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11155 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11156 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11157 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011158 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011159
11160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111618.9. Examples of logs
11162---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011163
11164These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11165them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11166reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11167
11168 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11169 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11170 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11171
11172 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11173 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11174
11175 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11176 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11177 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11178
11179 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11180 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11181
11182 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11183 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11184 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11185
11186 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011187 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011188 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11189 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11190
11191 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11192 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11193 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11194
11195 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11196 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011197 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011198 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11199 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11200 to return the 502 and not the server.
11201
11202 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011203 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011204
11205 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11206 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11207 Nothing was sent to any server.
11208
11209 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11210 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11211
11212 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11213 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11214 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11215 send a 408 return code to the client.
11216
11217 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11218 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11219
11220 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11221 5 seconds ("c----").
11222
11223 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11224 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011225 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011226
11227 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011228 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011229 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11230 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11231 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11232 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11233 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011234
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112369. Statistics and monitoring
11237----------------------------
11238
11239It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11240mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11241CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11242Unix socket.
11243
11244
112459.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011246---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011247
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011248The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11249page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011251 0. pxname: proxy name
11252 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11253 for server)
11254 2. qcur: current queued requests
11255 3. qmax: max queued requests
11256 4. scur: current sessions
11257 5. smax: max sessions
11258 6. slim: sessions limit
11259 7. stot: total sessions
11260 8. bin: bytes in
11261 9. bout: bytes out
11262 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011263 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011264 12. ereq: request errors
11265 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011266 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011267 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11268 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011269 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011270 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11271 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11272 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11273 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11274 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11275 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11276 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11277 25. qlimit: queue limit
11278 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11279 27. iid: unique proxy id
11280 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11281 29. throttle: warm up status
11282 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11283 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011284 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011285 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11286 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11287 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011288 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011289 UNK -> unknown
11290 INI -> initializing
11291 SOCKERR -> socket error
11292 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11293 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11294 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11295 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11296 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11297 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11298 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11299 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11300 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11301 disable-on-404
11302 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11303 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11304 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011305 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11306 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011307 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11308 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11309 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11310 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11311 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11312 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011313 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11314 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11315 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11316 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011317 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11318 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011319 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11320 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11321 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011322 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011323
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113259.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011326-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011327
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011328The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011329must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11330is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11331a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11332risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11333followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11334given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11335then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11336to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011337
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011338It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11339on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11340own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011341
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011342clear counters
11343 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11344 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11345 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11346 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11347 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11348
11349clear counters all
11350 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11351 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11352 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11353
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011354clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11355 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11356
11357 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11358 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11359 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11360 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11361 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11362 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11363
11364 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11365
11366 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11367 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11368 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11369 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11370 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11371 the ACLs :
11372
11373 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11374 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11375 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11376 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11377 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11378 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11379
11380 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011381 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11382 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011383
11384 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011385 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011386 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011387 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11388 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11389 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11390 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011391
11392 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11393
11394 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011395 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011396 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11397 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011398 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11399 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11400 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011401
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011402disable frontend <frontend>
11403 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11404 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11405 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11406 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11407 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11408 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11409 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11410 on the stats page.
11411
11412 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11413 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11414
11415 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11416 level "admin".
11417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011418disable server <backend>/<server>
11419 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11420 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11421 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11422 during the maintenance.
11423
11424 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11425 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11426
11427 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011428 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011429
11430 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11431 level "admin".
11432
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011433enable frontend <frontend>
11434 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11435 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11436 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11437 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11438 which was disabled.
11439
11440 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11441 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11442
11443 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11444 level "admin".
11445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011446enable server <backend>/<server>
11447 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11448 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11449
11450 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011451 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011452
11453 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11454 level "admin".
11455
11456get weight <backend>/<server>
11457 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11458 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11459 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11460 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11461 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011462 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011463
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011464help
11465 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11466 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011467
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011468prompt
11469 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11470 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11471 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11472 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11473 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11474 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11475 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11476 command.
11477
11478quit
11479 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011480
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011481set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011482 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11483 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11484 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11485 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11486 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011487 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11488 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11489
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011490set maxconn global <maxconn>
11491 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11492 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11493 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11494 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11495 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11496 setting.
11497
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011498set rate-limit connections global <value>
11499 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11500 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11501 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11502 is passed in number of connections per second.
11503
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011504set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11505 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11506 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011507 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11508 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011509
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011510set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11511 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11512 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11513 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11514 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11515 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011517set timeout cli <delay>
11518 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11519 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11520 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11521
11522set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11523 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11524 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090011525 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
11526 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
11527 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
11528 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
11529 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
11530 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
11531 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11532 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
11533 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
11534 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
11535 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
11536 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
11537 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011538
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011539show errors [<iid>]
11540 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11541 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011542 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11543 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11544 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011545
11546 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11547 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11548 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11549 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11550 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11551 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11552 are reported too.
11553
11554 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11555 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11556 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11557 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11558 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11559 code.
11560
11561 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11562 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11563 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11564 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11565 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11566 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11567 line.
11568
11569 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011570 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11571 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011572 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11573 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11574
11575 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11576 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11577 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11578 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11579 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11580 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11581 00204+ minal\r\n
11582 00211 \r\n
11583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011584 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011585 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11586 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11587 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11588 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11589 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11590 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011591
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011592show info
11593 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11594
11595show sess
11596 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011597 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11598 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11599
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011600show sess <id>
11601 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11602 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11603 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11604 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11605 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011606 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11607 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11608 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011609
11610show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11611 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11612 possible to dump only selected items :
11613 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11614 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11615 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11616 for example:
11617 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11618 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11619 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11620
11621 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011622 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11623 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011624 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11625 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11626 Nbproc: 1
11627 Process_num: 1
11628 (...)
11629
11630 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11631 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11632 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11633 (...)
11634 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11635
11636 $
11637
11638 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11639 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11640 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11641 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011642 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011643
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011644show table
11645 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11646 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11647 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11648 entries currently in use.
11649
11650 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011651 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011652 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11653 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011654
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011655show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011656 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11657 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11658 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011659 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11660
11661 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11662 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11663 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11664 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11665 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11666
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011667 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11668 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11669 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11670 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11671 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11672 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11673
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011674
11675 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011676 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11677 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011678
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011679 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011680 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011681 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011682 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11683 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11684 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11685 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011686
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011687 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011688 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011689 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11690 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011691
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011692 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11693 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011694 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011695 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11696 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011697
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011698 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11699 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011700 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011701 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11702 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11703
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011704 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11705 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11706 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11707 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11708 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11709
11710 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11711 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11712 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011713 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11714 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011715 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11716 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011717
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011718shutdown frontend <frontend>
11719 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11720 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11721 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11722 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11723 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11724 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11725 once it is terminated.
11726
11727 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11728 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11729
11730 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11731 level "admin".
11732
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011733shutdown session <id>
11734 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11735 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11736 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11737 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11738 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11739 flag in the logs.
11740
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011741shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11742 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11743 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11744 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11745 'K' flag in the logs.
11746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011747/*
11748 * Local variables:
11749 * fill-column: 79
11750 * End:
11751 */